]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
[multiple changes]
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
102@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
103A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
104takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
105option takes--zero, for many options.
106
107By default, this macro is defined as
108@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
109properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
110wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
111should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
112additional options.
113@end defmac
114
115@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
116A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
117takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
118option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
119@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
120
121By default, this macro is defined as
122@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
123properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
124wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
125should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
126additional options.
127@end defmac
128
129@defmac SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION (@var{char})
130A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
131stops compilation before the generation of an executable. The value is
132boolean, nonzero if the option does stop an executable from being
133generated, zero otherwise.
134
135By default, this macro is defined as
136@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION}, which handles the standard
137options properly. You need not define
138@code{SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} unless you wish to add additional
139options which affect the generation of an executable. Any redefinition
140should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_CURTAILS_COMPILATION} and then check
141for additional options.
142@end defmac
143
144@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
145If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
146potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
147second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
148supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
149target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
150are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
151must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
152provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
153such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
154multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
155@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
156
157@smallexample
158#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
159@{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
160@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
161@end smallexample
162@end defmac
163
164@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
165A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
166initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
167
168The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
169default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
170choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
171applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
172options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
173using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
174
175This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
176options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
177that the other specs are easier to write.
178
179Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
180@end defmac
181
182@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
183A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
184@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
185for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
186outermost pair of surrounding braces.
187
188The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
189the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
190to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
191@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
192everywhere it occurs.
193
194The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
195default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
196the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac CPP_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
203pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
204give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
205
206Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
207@end defmac
208
209@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
210This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
211than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
212@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
213@end defmac
214
215@defmac CC1_SPEC
216A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
217pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
218front ends.
219It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
220for GCC to pass to front ends.
221
222Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
223@end defmac
224
225@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
226A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
227pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
228give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
229
230Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
231Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
232@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
233CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
234@end defmac
235
236@defmac ASM_SPEC
237A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
238pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
239you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
240See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
241
242Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
243@end defmac
244
245@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
246A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
247run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
248Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
249an example of this.
250
251Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
252@end defmac
253
254@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
255Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
256an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
257read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
258output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
259@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
260
261If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
262standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
263cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
264see @file{mips.h} for instance.
265@end defmac
266
267@defmac LINK_SPEC
268A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
269pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
270give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
271
272Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
273@end defmac
274
275@defmac LIB_SPEC
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
277between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
278command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
281loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282@end defmac
283
284@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
285Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
286how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
287linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
288the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
289
290If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
291passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
295By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
296@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
297instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
298depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
299@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
300targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
301@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
302driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
303line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
304@end defmac
305
306@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
307A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
308mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
309generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
310static exception handler library, when linking without any of
311@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
312@end defmac
313
314@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
315If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
316When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
317the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
318@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
319@end defmac
320
321@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
322Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
323difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
324the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
325
326If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
327standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
328@end defmac
329
330@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
331Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
332difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
333the very end of the command given to the linker.
334
335Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
336@end defmac
337
338@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
339GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
340However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
341models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
342@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
343blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
344default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
345@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
346@end defmac
347
348@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
349Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
350configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
351et al, within sysroot+suffix.
352@end defmac
353
354@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
355Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
356GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
357updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
358usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
359@end defmac
360
361@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
362Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
363@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
364@code{CC1_SPEC}.
365
366The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
367containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
368string constant that provides the specification.
369
370Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
371
372@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
373related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
374to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
375these definitions.
376
377For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
378define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
379used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
380used.
381
382The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
383
384@smallexample
385#define EXTRA_SPECS \
386 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
387
388#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
389@end smallexample
390
391The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
392@smallexample
393#undef CPP_SPEC
394#define CPP_SPEC \
395"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
396%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
397%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
398%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
399
400#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
401#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
402@end smallexample
403
404while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
405@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
406
407@smallexample
408#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
409#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
410@end smallexample
411@end defmac
412
413@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
414Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
415@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
416the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
417@end defmac
418
419@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
420The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
421By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
422@end defmac
423
424@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
425A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
426linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
427change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
428define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
429line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
430the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
431@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
435A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
436directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
437removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
438@end defmac
439
440@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
441Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
442string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
443target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
444@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
445
446Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
447the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
448@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
449@xref{Target Fragment}.
450@end defmac
451
452@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
453Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
454a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
455indicates an absolute file name.
456@end defmac
457
458@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
459If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
460@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
461when the compiler is built as a cross
462compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
463to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
464@end defmac
465
466@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
470@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
471is built as a cross compiler.
472@end defmac
473
474@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
475Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
476standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
477when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
478@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
479is built as a cross compiler.
480@end defmac
481
482@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
483Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
484standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
485default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
486@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
487is built as a cross compiler.
488@end defmac
489
490@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
491If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
492standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
493compiler is built as a cross compiler.
494@end defmac
495
496@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
497If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
498standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
499cross compiler.
500@end defmac
501
502@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
503Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
504variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
505loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
506initialize the necessary environment variables.
507@end defmac
508
509@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
510Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
511standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
512try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
513comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
514
515Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
516replacement.
517@end defmac
518
519@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
520Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
521system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
522directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
523@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
524
525Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
526specified.
527@end defmac
528
529@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
530Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
531standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
532try when searching for header files.
533
534Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
535@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
536@end defmac
537
538@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
539The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
540See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
541If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
542@end defmac
543
544@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
545Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
546for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
547usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
548@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
549@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
550and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
551and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
552@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
553
554The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
555Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
556string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
557for C++-only directories,
558and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
559wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
560the array with a null element.
561
562The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
563if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
564or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
565operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
566
567For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
568
569@smallexample
570#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
571@{ \
572 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
573 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
574 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
575 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
576 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
577@}
578@end smallexample
579@end defmac
580
581Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
582
583@enumerate
584@item
585Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
586
587@item
588The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
589is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
590@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
591
592@item
593The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
594
595@item
596The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
597in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
598
599@item
600The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
601
602@item
603The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
604
605@item
606The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
607compiler.
608@end enumerate
609
610Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
611
612@enumerate
613@item
614Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
615
616@item
617The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
618value based on the installed toolchain location.
619
620@item
621The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
622(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
623
624@item
625The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
626in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
627
628@item
629The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
630
631@item
632The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
633compiler.
634
635@item
636The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
637native compiler, or we have a target system root.
638
639@item
640The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
641native compiler, or we have a target system root.
642
643@item
644The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
645If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
646the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
647
648@item
649The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
650compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
651@file{/lib/}.
652
653@item
654The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
655compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
656@file{/usr/lib/}.
657@end enumerate
658
659@node Run-time Target
660@section Run-time Target Specification
661@cindex run-time target specification
662@cindex predefined macros
663@cindex target specifications
664
665@c prevent bad page break with this line
666Here are run-time target specifications.
667
668@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
669This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
670built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
671the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
672@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
673calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
674finished command line option processing your code can use those
675results freely.
676
677@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
678command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
679the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
680accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
681
682@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
683object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
684@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
685defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
686with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
687only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
688example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
689and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
690@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
691defines only @code{_ABI64}.
692
693You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
694@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
695or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
696assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
697macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
698to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
699variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
700@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
701preprocessing.
702@end defmac
703
704@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
705Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
706and is used for the target operating system instead.
707@end defmac
708
709@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
710Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
711and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
712macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
713it yourself.
714@end defmac
715
716@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
717This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
718any target-specific headers.
719@end deftypevar
720
721@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
722This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
723Its default setting is 0.
724@end deftypevr
725
726@cindex optional hardware or system features
727@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
728
729@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
730This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
731target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
732(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
733processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
734definition does nothing but return true.
735
736@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
737associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
738the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
739underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
740no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
741(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
742argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
743option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
744@end deftypefn
745
746@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
747This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
748target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
749definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
750option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
751valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
752default definition does nothing but return false.
753
754In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
755options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
756only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
757should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
758@end deftypefn
759
26705988
IS
760@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING
761
38f8b050
JR
762@defmac TARGET_VERSION
763This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
764describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
765description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
766
767@smallexample
768#ifdef MOTOROLA
769#define TARGET_VERSION \
770 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
771#else
772#define TARGET_VERSION \
773 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
774#endif
775@end smallexample
776@end defmac
777
38f8b050
JR
778@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
779This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
780but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
781pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
782attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
783when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
784actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
785@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
786@end deftypefn
787
788@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
789This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
790but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
791language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
792used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
793frontends.
794@end defmac
795
fac0f722 796@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION
38f8b050 797Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
fac0f722 798various optimization levels. This hook, if defined, is executed once
38f8b050
JR
799just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
800of the command options have been parsed. Values set in this macro are
801used as the default values for the other command line options.
802
803@var{level} is the optimization level specified; 2 if @option{-O2} is
804specified, 1 if @option{-O} is specified, and 0 if neither is specified.
805
806@var{size} is nonzero if @option{-Os} is specified and zero otherwise.
807
808This macro is run once at program startup and when the optimization
809options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
810@code{optimize} attribute.
811
812@strong{Do not examine @code{write_symbols} in
fac0f722 813this hook!} The debugging options are not supposed to alter the
38f8b050 814generated code.
fac0f722 815@end deftypefn
38f8b050 816
7e4aae92
JM
817@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
818
128dc8e2
JM
819@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
820
38f8b050
JR
821@hook TARGET_HELP
822This hook is called in response to the user invoking
823@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
824chance to display extra information on the target specific command
825line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
826@end deftypefn
827
828@defmac CAN_DEBUG_WITHOUT_FP
829Define this macro if debugging can be performed even without a frame
830pointer. If this macro is defined, GCC will turn on the
831@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} option whenever @option{-O} is specified.
832@end defmac
833
3bd36029
RS
834@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
835Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
836during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
837the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
838can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
839and @code{nomips16} attributes.
840
841Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
842registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
843operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
844in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
845significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
846for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
847switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
848
849Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
850is 0.
851@end defmac
852
38f8b050
JR
853@node Per-Function Data
854@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
855@cindex per-function data
856@cindex data structures
857
858If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
859provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
860using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
861nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
862when another one comes along.
863
864GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
865contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
866structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
867@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
868to their own specific data.
869
870If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
871@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
872This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
873@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
874
875One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
876RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
877RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
878function, for level 0.
879
880Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
881all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
882function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
883stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
884stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
885@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
886the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
887single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
888longer supported.
889
890@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
891Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
892is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
893The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
894function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
895@end defmac
896
897@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
898If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
899function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
900target to perform any target specific initialization of the
901@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
902used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
903
904@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
905Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
906GC allocation, including the structure itself.
907@end deftypevar
908
909@node Storage Layout
910@section Storage Layout
911@cindex storage layout
912
913Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
914alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
915expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
916@xref{Run-time Target}.
917
918@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
919Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
920byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
921This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
922bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
923be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
924macro need not be a constant.
925
926This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
927bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
928@end defmac
929
930@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
931Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
932word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
933@end defmac
934
935@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
936Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
937most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
938memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
939order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
940macro need not be a constant.
941@end defmac
942
943@defmac LIBGCC2_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
944Define this macro if @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} is not constant. This must be a
945constant value with the same meaning as @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN}, which will be
946used only when compiling @file{libgcc2.c}. Typically the value will be set
947based on preprocessor defines.
948@end defmac
949
950@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
951Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
952@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
953containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
954have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
955
956You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
957multi-word integers.
958@end defmac
959
960@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
961Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
962unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
963@end defmac
964
965@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
966Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
967is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
968@end defmac
969
970@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
971Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
972@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
973largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
974@end defmac
975
976@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
977Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
978register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
979@end defmac
980
981@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
982Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
983@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
984smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
985@end defmac
986
38f8b050
JR
987@defmac POINTER_SIZE
988Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
989width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
990you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
991a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
992@end defmac
993
994@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
995A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
996@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
997greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
998should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
999is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
1000@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
1001
1002You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
1003and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
1004@end defmac
1005
1006@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
1007A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
1008is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
1009stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
1010scalar type.
1011
1012On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
1013register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
1014@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
1015cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
1016floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
1017counterparts.
1018
1019For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
1020However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
1021either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
1022the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
1023sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
1024@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
1025
1026Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
1027@end defmac
1028
1029@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
1030Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
1031function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
1032and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
1033change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
1034pointer} types.
1035
1036@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
1037return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
1038@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
1039If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
1040which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
1041then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
1042the signedness may be different.
1043
1044The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
1045also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
1046if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1047@end deftypefn
1048
1049@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1050Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1051bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1052regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1053size of an integer.
1054@end defmac
1055
1056@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1057Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1058stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1059desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1060if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1061this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1062@end defmac
1063
1064@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1065Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1066stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1067is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1068macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1069@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1070@end defmac
1071
1072@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1073Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1074from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1075to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1076@end defmac
1077
1078@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1079Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1080@end defmac
1081
1082@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1083Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1084bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1085just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1086@end defmac
1087
1088@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1089Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1090provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1091@end defmac
1092
1093@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1094Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1095not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1096@end defmac
1097
1098@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1099If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1100object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1101nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1102on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1103@end defmac
1104
1105@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1106Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1107machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1108structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1109by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1110@end defmac
1111
1112@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1113An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1114alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1115@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1116alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1117field alignment has not been set by the
1118@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1119@end defmac
1120
1121@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1122Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1123to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1124
1125If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1126
1127@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1128@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1129@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1130@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1131@end defmac
1132
1133@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1134Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1135Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1136@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1137the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1138
1139On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1140the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1141a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1142On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1143@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1144@end defmac
1145
1146@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1147If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1148the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1149the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1150macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1151
1152If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1153
1154@findex strcpy
1155One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1156make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1157arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1158constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1159@end defmac
1160
1161@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1162If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1163that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1164@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1165have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1166align the object.
1167
1168If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1169
1170The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1171constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1172constants can be done inline.
1173@end defmac
1174
1175@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1176If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1177the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1178the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1179macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1180
1181If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1182
1183One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1184make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1185@end defmac
1186
1187@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1188If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1189@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1190and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1191have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1192align the slot.
1193
1194If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1195@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1196be used.
1197
1198This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1199of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1200@end defmac
1201
1202@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1203If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1204variable @var{decl}.
1205
1206If this macro is not defined, then
1207@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1208is used.
1209
1210One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1211make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1212@end defmac
1213
1214@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1215If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1216for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1217@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1218
1219If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1220@end defmac
1221
1222@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1223Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1224empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1225
1226If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1227@end defmac
1228
1229@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1230Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1231Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1232
1233If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1234@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1235@end defmac
1236
1237@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1238Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1239if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1240go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1241@end defmac
1242
1243@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1244Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1245alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1246
1247The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1248@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1249structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1250that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1251that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1252
1253Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1254@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1255four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1256not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1257
1258An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1259structure.
1260
1261If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1262a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1263
1264Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1265bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1266support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1267@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1268
1269The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1270@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1271Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1272
1273Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1274@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1275@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1276
1277If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1278bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1279what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1280
1281@smallexample
1282struct foo1
1283@{
1284 char x;
1285 char :0;
1286 char y;
1287@};
1288
1289struct foo2
1290@{
1291 char x;
1292 int :0;
1293 char y;
1294@};
1295
1296main ()
1297@{
1298 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1299 sizeof (struct foo1));
1300 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1301 sizeof (struct foo2));
1302 exit (0);
1303@}
1304@end smallexample
1305
1306If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1307get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1308@end defmac
1309
1310@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1311Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1312to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1313@end defmac
1314
1315@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1316When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1317whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1318structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1319the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1320@end deftypefn
1321
1322@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1323This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1324should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1325these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1326
1327The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1328@end deftypefn
1329
1330@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1331Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1332@code{BLKMODE}.
1333
1334If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1335mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1336case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1337retain the field's mode.
1338
1339Normally, this is not needed.
1340@end defmac
1341
1342@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1343Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1344by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1345way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1346@var{specified}.
1347
1348The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1349the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1350@end defmac
1351
1352@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1353An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1354machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1355this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1356appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1357(DImode)} is assumed.
1358@end defmac
1359
1360@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1361If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1362specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1363@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1364@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1365@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1366having its mode specified.
1367
1368You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1369would most commonly define this macro if the
1370@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
137164-bit mode.
1372@end defmac
1373
1374@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1375If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1376specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1377@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1378
1379You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1380You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1381pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1382@end defmac
1383
1384@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1385This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1386of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1387@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1388targets.
1389@end deftypefn
1390
1391@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1392This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1393of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1394@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1395targets.
1396@end deftypefn
1397
1398@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1399Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1400The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1401@end deftypefn
1402
1403@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1404If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1405mode is towards zero.
1406
1407Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1408floating-point arithmetic.
1409
1410Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1411@end defmac
1412
1413@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1414This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1415bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1416exponent for normal numbers instead.
1417
1418Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1419floating-point arithmetic.
1420
1421The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1422@end defmac
1423
1424@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1425This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1426@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1427Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1428unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1429different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1430alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1431bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1432the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1433(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1434another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1435other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1436
1437When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1438of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1439bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1440and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1441chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1442size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1443alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1444
1445If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1446the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1447used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1448precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1449may affect its placement.
1450@end deftypefn
1451
1452@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1453Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1454@end deftypefn
1455
1456@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1457Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1458@end deftypefn
1459
1460@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1461This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1462to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1463For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1464for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1465registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1466usage.
1467@end deftypefn
1468
1469@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1470This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1471that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1472@end deftypefn
1473
1474@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1475If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1476uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1477to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1478mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1479the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1480not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1481for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1482return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1483string constant.
1484
1485Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1486qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1487fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1488is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1489length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1490ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1491@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1492@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1493code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1494@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1495codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1496spaces in your string.
1497
1498This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1499name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1500can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1501before mangling.
1502
1503The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1504appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1505types.
1506@end deftypefn
1507
1508@node Type Layout
1509@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1510
1511These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1512basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1513the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1514languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1515
1516@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1517A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1518target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1519@end defmac
1520
1521@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1522A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1523target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1524(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1525unit.)
1526@end defmac
1527
1528@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1529A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1530target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1531@end defmac
1532
1533@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1534On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1535@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1536that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1537the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1538value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1539@end defmac
1540
1541@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1542A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1543target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1544words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1545macro must be at least 64.
1546@end defmac
1547
1548@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1549A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1550target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1555A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1556C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1557this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1558@end defmac
1559
1560@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1561A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1562target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1563@end defmac
1564
1565@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1566A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1567target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1568words.
1569@end defmac
1570
1571@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1572A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1573the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1574words.
1575@end defmac
1576
1577@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1578A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1579the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1580@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1581@end defmac
1582
1583@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1584A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1585the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1586@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1587@end defmac
1588
1589@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1590A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1591the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1592@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1593@end defmac
1594
1595@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1596A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1597the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1598@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1599@end defmac
1600
1601@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1602A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1603the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1604@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1605@end defmac
1606
1607@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1608A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1609the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1610@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1614A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1615the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1616@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1617@end defmac
1618
1619@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1620A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1621the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1622@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1623@end defmac
1624
1625@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1626Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1627if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1628@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1629default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1630@end defmac
1631
1632@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1633Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1634@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1635@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1636anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1637or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1638otherwise it is 0.
1639@end defmac
1640
1641@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1642Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1643@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1644anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1645is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1646@end defmac
1647
1648@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1649Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1650@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1651anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1652is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1653@end defmac
1654
1655@defmac SF_SIZE
1656@defmacx DF_SIZE
1657@defmacx XF_SIZE
1658@defmacx TF_SIZE
1659Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1660@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1661if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1662@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1663for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1664@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1665@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1666@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1667@end defmac
1668
1669@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1670A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1671assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1672default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1673@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1674@end defmac
1675
1676@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1677A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1678supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1679value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1680If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1681is the default.
1682@end defmac
1683
1684@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1685An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1686@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1687always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1688and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1689@end defmac
1690
1691@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1692This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1693@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1694of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1695@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1696
1697The default is to return false.
1698@end deftypefn
1699
1700@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1701A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1702for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1703contents of the string.
1704
1705The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1706spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1707appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1708of the data type names defined in the function
1709@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1710omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1711crash on startup.
1712
1713If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1714int"}.
1715@end defmac
1716
1717@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1718A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1719for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1720@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1721@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1722
1723If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1724@end defmac
1725
1726@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1727A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1728for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1729the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1730information.
1731
1732If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1733@end defmac
1734
1735@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1736A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1737characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1738@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1739@end defmac
1740
1741@defmac WINT_TYPE
1742A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1743use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1744@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1745contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1746information.
1747
1748If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1749@end defmac
1750
1751@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1752A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1753can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1754The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1755string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1756
1757If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1758@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1759much precision as @code{long long int}.
1760@end defmac
1761
1762@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1763A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1764can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1765type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1766of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1767
1768If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1769@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1770unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1771int}.
1772@end defmac
1773
1774@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1775@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1776@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1777@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1778@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1779@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1780@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1781@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1782@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1783@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1784@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1785@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1786@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1787@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1788@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1789@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1790@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1791@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1792@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1793@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1794@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1795@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1796@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1797@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1798@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1799@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1800@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1801C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1802@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1803@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1804@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1805@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1806@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1807@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1808@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1809@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1810@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1811
1812If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1813type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1814@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1815to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1816these macros are null pointers.
1817@end defmac
1818
1819@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1820The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1821that looks like:
1822
1823@smallexample
1824 struct @{
1825 union @{
1826 void (*fn)();
1827 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1828 @};
1829 ptrdiff_t delta;
1830 @};
1831@end smallexample
1832
1833@noindent
1834The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1835will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1836Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1837always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1838distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1839platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1840that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1841the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1842
1843GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1844this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1845However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1846set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1847bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1848address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1849architecture, you should define this macro to
1850@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1851
1852In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1853in which function addresses are always even, according to
1854@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1855@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1856@end defmac
1857
1858@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1859Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1860macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1861instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1862function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1863data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1864pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1865
1866If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1867of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1868@end defmac
1869
1870@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1871By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1872is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1873the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1874when special alignment is necessary. */
1875@end defmac
1876
1877@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1878There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1879zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1880specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1881of words in each data entry.
1882@end defmac
1883
1884@node Registers
1885@section Register Usage
1886@cindex register usage
1887
1888This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1889has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1890
1891The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1892done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1893on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1894For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1895For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1896
1897@menu
1898* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1899* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1900* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1901* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1902* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1903@end menu
1904
1905@node Register Basics
1906@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1907
1908@c prevent bad page break with this line
1909Registers have various characteristics.
1910
1911@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1912Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1913numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1914pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1915@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1916@end defmac
1917
1918@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1919@cindex fixed register
1920An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1921all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1922general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1923pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1924register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1925machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1926and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1927
1928This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1929commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1930register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1931
1932The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1933the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1934by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1935the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1936@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1937@end defmac
1938
1939@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1940@cindex call-used register
1941@cindex call-clobbered register
1942@cindex call-saved register
1943Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1944clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1945registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1946available for general allocation of values that must live across
1947function calls.
1948
1949If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1950automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1951exit, if the register is used within the function.
1952@end defmac
1953
1954@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1955@cindex call-used register
1956@cindex call-clobbered register
1957@cindex call-saved register
1958Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1959that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1960(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1961This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1962of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1963@end defmac
1964
1965@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1966@cindex call-used register
1967@cindex call-clobbered register
1968@cindex call-saved register
1969A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1970value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1971call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1972macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1973preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1974@end defmac
1975
1976@findex fixed_regs
1977@findex call_used_regs
1978@findex global_regs
1979@findex reg_names
1980@findex reg_class_contents
1981@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1982Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1983@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1984@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1985any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1986of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1987@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1988@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1989called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1990@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1991from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1992@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1993@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1994@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1995command options have been applied.
1996
1997You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1998
1999@cindex disabling certain registers
2000@cindex controlling register usage
2001If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
2002flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
2003@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
2004registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
2005the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2006to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
2007is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
2008
2009(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
2010of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
2011controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
2012these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
2013@end defmac
2014
2015@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
2016Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2017expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
2018corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
2019function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
2020outbound register.
2021@end defmac
2022
2023@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
2024Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2025expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
2026corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
2027function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
2028register.
2029@end defmac
2030
2031@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
2032Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
2033expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
2034register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2035need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2036gotos.
2037@end defmac
2038
2039@defmac PC_REGNUM
2040If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2041register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2042@end defmac
2043
2044@node Allocation Order
2045@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2046@cindex order of register allocation
2047@cindex register allocation order
2048
2049@c prevent bad page break with this line
2050Registers are allocated in order.
2051
2052@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2053If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2054numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2055to use them (from most preferred to least).
2056
2057If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2058(all else being equal).
2059
2060One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2061registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2062instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2063machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2064the highest numbered allocable register first.
2065@end defmac
2066
2067@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2068A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2069hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2070
2071Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2072Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2073register; and so on.
2074
2075The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2076@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2077
2078On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2079@end defmac
2080
2081@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2082Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2083prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2084using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2085allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2086call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2087should be defined.
2088@end defmac
2089
2090@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2091In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2092Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2093If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2094based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2095be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2096value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2097to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2098
2099On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2100@end defmac
2101
2102@node Values in Registers
2103@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2104
2105This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2106(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2107consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2108
2109@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2110A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2111at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2112@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2113cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2114and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2115
2116On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2117definition of this macro is
2118
2119@smallexample
2120#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2121 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2122 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2123@end smallexample
2124@end defmac
2125
2126@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2127A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2128in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2129in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2130multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2131this mode by the number of registers returned by
2132@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2133
2134For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2135registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2136nonzero.
2137
2138This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2139@code{subreg_get_info}
2140would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2141represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2142@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2143registers and so not be representable.
2144@end defmac
2145
2146@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2147For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2148@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2149returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2150including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2151@end defmac
2152
2153@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2154Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2155of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2156should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2157used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2158happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2159floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2160@end defmac
2161
2162@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2163A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2164of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2165registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2166are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2167
2168@smallexample
2169#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2170@end smallexample
2171
2172You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2173because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2174
2175@cindex register pairs
2176On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2177register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2178odd register numbers for such modes.
2179
2180The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2181@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2182register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2183value into the register and back out not alter it.
2184
2185Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2186all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2187@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2188you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2189is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2190and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2191to be tieable.
2192
2193Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2194Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2195in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2196can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2197mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2198registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2199
2200On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2201modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2202registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2203non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2204@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2205floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2206normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2207unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2208register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2209
2210The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2211they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2212instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2213@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2214constraints for those instructions.
2215
2216On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2217so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2218register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2219floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2220be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2221@end defmac
2222
2223@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2224A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2225@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2226
2227One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2228another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2229handler.
2230
2231The default is always nonzero.
2232@end defmac
2233
2234@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2235A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2236@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2237
2238If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2239@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2240any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2241should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2242this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2243accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2244
2245You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2246possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2247allocation.
2248@end defmac
2249
2250@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2251This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2252@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2253
2254One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2255is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2256
2257The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2258@end deftypefn
2259
2260@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2261Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2262registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2263@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2264@end defmac
2265
2266@node Leaf Functions
2267@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2268
2269@cindex leaf functions
2270@cindex functions, leaf
2271On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2272more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2273means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2274are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2275normally arrive.
2276
2277The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2278other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2279registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2280function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2281handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2282functions''.
2283
2284GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2285suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2286registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2287accomplish this.
2288
2289@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2290Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2291contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2292function treatment.
2293
2294If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2295registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2296GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2297used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2298in this vector.
2299
2300Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2301the treatment of leaf functions.
2302@end defmac
2303
2304@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2305A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2306should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2307
2308If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2309function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2310will cause the compiler to abort.
2311
2312Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2313treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2314this.
2315@end defmac
2316
2317@findex current_function_is_leaf
2318@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2319@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2320@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2321specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2322which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2323set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2324compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2325@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2326functions which only use leaf registers.
2327@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2328that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2329@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2330@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2331@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2332
2333@node Stack Registers
2334@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2335
2336There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2337``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2338pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2339stack.
2340
2341Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2342they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2343support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2344point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2345stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2346@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2347with it, as well as defining these macros.
2348
2349@defmac STACK_REGS
2350Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2351@end defmac
2352
2353@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2354This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2355the machine has any stack-like registers.
2356@end defmac
2357
2358@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2359The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2360of the stack.
2361@end defmac
2362
2363@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2364The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2365the stack.
2366@end defmac
2367
2368@node Register Classes
2369@section Register Classes
2370@cindex register class definitions
2371@cindex class definitions, register
2372
2373On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2374For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2375certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2376restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2377
2378You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2379which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2380that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2381
2382@findex ALL_REGS
2383@findex NO_REGS
2384In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2385class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2386class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2387union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2388
2389@findex GENERAL_REGS
2390One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2391terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2392@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2393the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2394to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2395
2396Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2397then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2398
2399The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2400constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2401You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2402them in operand constraints.
2403
2404You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2405instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2406either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2407certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2408which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2409
2410You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2411classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2412contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2413in their union.
2414
2415When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2416certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2417Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2418a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2419specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2420
2421Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2422instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2423each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2424mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2425single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2426this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2427instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2428single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2429@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2430
2431@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2432An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2433as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2434must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2435@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2436tells how many classes there are.
2437
2438Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2439the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2440in many of the tables described below.
2441@end deftp
2442
2443@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2444The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2445
2446@smallexample
2447#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2448@end smallexample
2449@end defmac
2450
2451@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2452An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2453constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2454@end defmac
2455
2456@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2457An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2458which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2459@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2460register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2461
2462When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2463Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2464several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2465for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2466In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2467registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2468so on.
2469@end defmac
2470
2471@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2472A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2473@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2474which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2475register.
2476@end defmac
2477
2478@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2479A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2480base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2481which is the register value plus a displacement.
2482@end defmac
2483
2484@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2485This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2486the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2487@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2488@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2489@end defmac
2490
2491@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2492A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2493base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2494register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2495addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2496@end defmac
2497
2498@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2499A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2500base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2501context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2502the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2503address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2504@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2505index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2506@end defmac
2507
2508@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2509A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2510index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2511address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2512added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2513@end defmac
2514
2515@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2516A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2517suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2518Like @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}, this macro should also
2519define a strict and a non-strict variant. Both variants behave
2520the same for hard register; for pseudos, the strict variant will
2521pass only those that have been allocated to a valid hard registers,
2522while the non-strict variant will pass all pseudos.
2523
2524@findex REG_OK_STRICT
2525Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this and
2526other macros define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
2527@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
2528that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
2529@end defmac
2530
2531@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2532A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2533that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2534@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2535reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2536you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2537@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2538addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2539@code{address_operand}.
2540
2541This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2542@end defmac
2543
2544@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2545A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2546use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2547memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2548pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2549define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2550than other base register uses.
2551
2552Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2553@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2554
2555This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2556@end defmac
2557
2558@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2559A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2560that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2561appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2562immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2563address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2564@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2565corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2566@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2567that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2568
2569This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2570@end defmac
2571
2572@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2573A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2574suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2575either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2576allocated such a hard register.
2577
2578The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2579the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2580two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2581labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2582labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2583may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2584looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2585only if neither labeling works.
2586
2587This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2588@end defmac
2589
fba42e24
AS
2590@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2591A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2592to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2593@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2594another, smaller class.
2595
2596The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2597
2598Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2599example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2600for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2601@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2602Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2603
2604One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2605@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2606loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2607force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2608immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2609instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2610register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2611@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2612into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2613@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2614of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2615
2616If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2617through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2618to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2619reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2620this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2621the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2622@end deftypefn
2623
38f8b050
JR
2624@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2625A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2626to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2627@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2628another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2629safe:
2630
2631@smallexample
2632#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2633@end smallexample
2634
2635Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2636example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2637for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2638@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2639Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2640
2641One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2642@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2643loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2644force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2645immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2646instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2647register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2648@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2649into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2650@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2651of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2652
2653If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2654through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2655to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2656reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2657this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2658the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2659@end defmac
2660
2661@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2662Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2663input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2664@var{class}, unchanged.
2665
2666You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2667reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2668@end defmac
2669
abd26bfb
AS
2670@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2671Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2672input reloads.
2673
2674The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2675argument.
2676
2677You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2678reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2679@end deftypefn
2680
38f8b050
JR
2681@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2682A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2683to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2684@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2685ordinarily be used.
2686
2687Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2688there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2689
2690The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2691smaller class.
2692
2693Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2694require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2695@end defmac
2696
2697@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2698Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2699from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2700@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2701from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2702term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2703directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2704register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2705destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2706source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2707reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2708and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2709intermediate register still holds the required value.
2710
2711Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2712allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2713register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2714address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2715when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2716as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2717that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2718describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2719these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2720of the scratch register(s).
2721
2722In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2723
2724For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2725and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2726@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2727hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2728needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2729
2730If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2731an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2732return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2733If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2734If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2735that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2736
2737If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2738perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2739closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2740required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2741copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2742
2743You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2744in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2745and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2746for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2747single-register-class
2748@c [later: or memory]
2749output constraint.
2750
2751When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2752hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2753register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2754have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2755
2756@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2757@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2758@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2759@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2760@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2761@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2762@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2763@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2764
2765
2766@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2767pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2768Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2769in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2770
2771Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2772currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2773to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2774
2775@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2776copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2777(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2778Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2779of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2780forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2781@end deftypefn
2782
2783@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2784@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2785@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2786These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2787@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2788
2789These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2790target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2791reload phase that it may
2792need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2793register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2794register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2795you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2796largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2797intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2798
2799If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2800intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2801was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2802class required. If the
2803requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2804@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2805macros identically.
2806
2807The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2808Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2809can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2810@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2811macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2812
2813If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2814intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2815@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2816(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2817implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2818@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2819register.
2820
2821These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2822register that
2823contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2824class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2825value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2826register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2827Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2828
2829@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2830pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2831Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2832in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2833
2834These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2835registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2836registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2837would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2838the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2839intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2840general registers.
2841@end defmac
2842
2843@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2844Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2845to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2846those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2847@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2848class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2849and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2850
2851Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2852@end defmac
2853
2854@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2855Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2856allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2857If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2858defined by this macro.
2859
2860Do not define this macro if you do not define
2861@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2862@end defmac
2863
2864@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2865When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2866registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2867hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2868load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2869same as that of @var{mode}.
2870
2871This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2872bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2873in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2874registers.
2875
2876However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2877the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2878differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2879widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2880suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2881details.
2882
2883Do not define this macro if you do not define
2884@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2885is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2886@end defmac
2887
07b8f0a8
AS
2888@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2889A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2890to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2891registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2892
2893The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2894has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2895default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2896if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2897hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2898@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2899@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2900register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2901you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2902the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2903allocation.
2904@end deftypefn
2905
38f8b050
JR
2906@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2907A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2908of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2909
2910This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2911the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2912should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2913@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2914
2915This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2916in the reload pass.
2917@end defmac
2918
2919@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2920If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2921a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2922
2923For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2924floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2925Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2926does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2927register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2928as below:
2929
2930@smallexample
2931#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2932 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2933 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2934@end smallexample
2935@end defmac
2936
2937@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2938Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2939(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2940classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2941purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2942possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2943The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2944
2945The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2946have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2947the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2948
2949This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2950options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2951@code{target_reinit}.
2952
2953The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2954otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2955macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2956allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2957the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2958@end deftypefn
2959
2960@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2961See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2962@end defmac
2963
2964@node Old Constraints
2965@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2966@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2967@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2968
2969Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2970of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2971Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2972it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2973
2974@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2975For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2976@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2977constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2978you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2979constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2980DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2981to handle specially.
2982There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2983for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2984transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2985return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2986will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2987@end defmac
2988
2989@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2990A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2991letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2992value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2993the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2994corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2995to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2996@end defmac
2997
2998@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2999Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
3000passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
3001different variants.
3002@end defmac
3003
3004@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
3005A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
3006letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
3007particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
3008letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
3009the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
3010not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
3011@var{value}.
3012@end defmac
3013
3014@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3015Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3016string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3017between different variants.
3018@end defmac
3019
3020@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
3021A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
3022letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
3023(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
3024
3025If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
3026@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
3027range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
3028letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3029
3030@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
3031@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
3032or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
3033between these kinds.
3034@end defmac
3035
3036@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3037Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3038string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3039between different variants.
3040@end defmac
3041
3042@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
3043A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3044letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
3045memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
3046elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3047@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3048may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3049
3050If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3051if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3052constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3053constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3054
3055For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3056in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3057letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3058@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3059a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3060alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3061does not include r0 on the output.
3062@end defmac
3063
3064@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3065Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3066in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3067variants.
3068@end defmac
3069
3070@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3071A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3072letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3073be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3074
3075It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3076at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3077comprises a subset of all memory references including
3078all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3079pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3080type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3081
3082For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3083memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3084register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3085@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3086If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3087a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3088reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3089into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3090an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3091@end defmac
3092
3093@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3094A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3095letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3096@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3097be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3098
3099It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3100at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3101a subset of all memory addresses including
3102all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3103pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3104type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3105
3106Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3107be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3108analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3109@end defmac
3110
3111@node Stack and Calling
3112@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3113@cindex calling conventions
3114
3115@c prevent bad page break with this line
3116This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3117
3118@menu
3119* Frame Layout::
3120* Exception Handling::
3121* Stack Checking::
3122* Frame Registers::
3123* Elimination::
3124* Stack Arguments::
3125* Register Arguments::
3126* Scalar Return::
3127* Aggregate Return::
3128* Caller Saves::
3129* Function Entry::
3130* Profiling::
3131* Tail Calls::
3132* Stack Smashing Protection::
3133@end menu
3134
3135@node Frame Layout
3136@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3137@cindex stack frame layout
3138@cindex frame layout
3139
3140@c prevent bad page break with this line
3141Here is the basic stack layout.
3142
3143@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3144Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3145pointer to a smaller address.
3146
3147When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3148compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3149definition used does not matter.
3150@end defmac
3151
3152@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3153This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3154on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3155@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3156
3157The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3158and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3159the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3160to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3161space for the next item on the stack.
3162
3163The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3164defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3165which is often wrong.
3166@end defmac
3167
3168@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3169Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3170are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3171@end defmac
3172
3173@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3174Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3175addresses on the stack.
3176@end defmac
3177
3178@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3179Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3180
3181If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3182subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3183Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3184value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3185@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3186@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3187@end defmac
3188
3189@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3190Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3191The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3192
3193On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3194is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3195alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3196stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3197@end defmac
3198
3199@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3200Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3201outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3202zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3203
3204If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3205the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3206@end defmac
3207
3208@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3209Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3210address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3211function.
3212
3213If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3214the first argument's address.
3215@end defmac
3216
3217@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3218Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3219on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3220
3221The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3222length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3223machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3224@end defmac
3225
3226@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3227A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3228stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3229@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3230default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3231elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3232@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3233@end defmac
3234
3235@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3236A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3237frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3238@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3239itself.
3240
3241If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3242of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3243address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3244@end defmac
3245
3246@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3247If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3248setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3249on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3250before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3251define this macro.
3252@end defmac
3253
3254@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3255This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3256the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3257The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3258machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3259@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3260@end deftypefn
3261
3262@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3263A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3264address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3265of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3266You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3267as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3268@end defmac
3269
3270@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3271A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3272address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3273the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3274frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3275@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3276
3277The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3278@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3279determine the return address of other frames.
3280@end defmac
3281
3282@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3283Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3284from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3285@end defmac
3286
3287@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3288A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3289incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3290prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3291value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3292the stack.
3293
3294You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3295debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3296
3297If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3298@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3299@end defmac
3300
3301@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3302A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3303number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3304must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3305be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3306
3307This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3308general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3309frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3310over time.
3311@end defmac
3312
3313@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3314A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3315number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3316only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3317someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3318terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3319@end defmac
3320
3321@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3322This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3323contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3324info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3325@smallexample
3326(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3327@end smallexample
3328and
3329@smallexample
3330(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3331@end smallexample
3332to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3333the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3334the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3335@end deftypefn
3336
3337@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3338A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3339from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3340frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3341the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3342previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3343
3344You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3345debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3346@end defmac
3347
3348@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3349A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3350from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3351final value should coincide with that calculated by
3352@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3353during virtual register instantiation.
3354
3355The default value for this macro is
3356@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3357which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3358immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3359some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3360and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3361
3362You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3363want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3364DWARF 2.
3365@end defmac
3366
3367@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3368If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3369in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3370The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3371@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3372
3373Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3374via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3375variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3376defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3377based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3378of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3379should be defined.
3380@end defmac
3381
3382@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3383If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3384in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3385in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3386may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3387@end defmac
3388
3389@node Exception Handling
3390@subsection Exception Handling Support
3391@cindex exception handling
3392
3393@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3394A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3395data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3396@var{N} registers are usable.
3397
3398The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3399handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3400should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3401but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
34022 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3403
3404You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3405handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3406@end defmac
3407
3408@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3409A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3410to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3411This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3412It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3413
3414Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3415untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3416
3417Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3418by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3419this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3420stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3421this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3422that provided by DWARF 2.
3423@end defmac
3424
3425@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3426A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3427to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3428return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3429
3430Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3431return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3432address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3433the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3434frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3435been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3436target call frame.
3437
3438Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3439address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3440the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3441
3442If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3443define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3444@end defmac
3445
3446@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3447If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3448to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3449exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3450using it to return to the exception handler.
3451@end defmac
3452
3453@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3454This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3455handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3456that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3457and so may be read-only.
3458
3459@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3460@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3461The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3462as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3463
3464If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3465represented directly.
3466@end defmac
3467
3468@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3469This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3470to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3471Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3472be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3473
3474This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3475handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3476of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3477to be emitted.
3478@end defmac
3479
3480@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3481A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3482so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3483@end defmac
3484
3485@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3486This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3487code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3488available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3489through signal frames.
3490
3491This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3492@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3493@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3494@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3495for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3496the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3497save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3498evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3499the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3500
3501For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3502@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3503@end defmac
3504
3505@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3506This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3507call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3508usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3509
3510This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3511@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3512@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3513for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3514@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3515be updated in @var{fs}.
3516@end defmac
3517
3518@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3519A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3520info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3521linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3522@end defmac
3523
3524@node Stack Checking
3525@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3526
3527GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3528stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3529three ways:
3530
3531@enumerate
3532@item
3533If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3534will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3535at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3536other special processing.
3537
3538@item
3539If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3540@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3541that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3542static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3543in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3544stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3545approach below.
3546
3547@item
3548If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3549``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3550@end enumerate
3551
3552If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3553GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3554@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3555dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3556
3557@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3558A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3559machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3560is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3561checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3562value of this macro is zero.
3563@end defmac
3564
3565@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3566A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3567in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3568like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3569approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3570@end defmac
3571
3572@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3573An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3574instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3575define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3576the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3577of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3578@end defmac
3579
3580@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3581An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3582when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3583contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3584thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3585is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3586default value of this macro is zero.
3587@end defmac
3588
3589@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3590The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3591languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3592with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35938192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3594most machines.
3595@end defmac
3596
3597The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3598nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3599in the opposite case.
3600
3601@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3602The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3603instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3604stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3605checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3606default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3607systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3608@end defmac
3609
3610@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3611GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3612represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3613space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3614You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3615use the default of four words.
3616@end defmac
3617
3618@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3619The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3620fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3621@option{-fstack-check}.
3622GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3623normally not need to override that default.
3624@end defmac
3625
3626@need 2000
3627@node Frame Registers
3628@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3629
3630@c prevent bad page break with this line
3631This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3632
3633@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3634The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3635fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3636the hardware determines which register this is.
3637@end defmac
3638
3639@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3640The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3641access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3642hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3643choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3644@end defmac
3645
3646@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3647On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3648offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3649allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3650between these two locations). On those machines, define
3651@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3652be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3653@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3654used for the frame pointer.
3655
3656You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3657is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3658the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3659completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3660definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3661@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3662or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3663
3664Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3665@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3666@end defmac
3667
3668@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3669The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3670the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3671frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3672register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3673wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3674pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3675@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3676(@pxref{Elimination}).
3677@end defmac
3678
e3339d0f
JM
3679@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3680Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3681@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3682the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3683== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3684definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3685@end defmac
3686
3687@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3688Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3689@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3690same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3691ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3692definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3693@end defmac
3694
38f8b050
JR
3695@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3696The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3697access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3698machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3699pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3700to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3701@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3702
3703Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3704address from the stack.
3705@end defmac
3706
3707@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3708@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3709Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3710register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3711function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3712number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3713these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3714not be defined.
3715
3716The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3717
3718If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3719defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3720@end defmac
3721
3722@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3723This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3724targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3725nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3726attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3727those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3728
3729The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3730
3731If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3732provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3733Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3734from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3735will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3736@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3737@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3738@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3739The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3740@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3741to refer to those items.
3742@end deftypefn
3743
3744@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3745This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3746saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3747DWARF2 exception handling.
3748
3749Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3750exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3751extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3752in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3753used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3754routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3755registers that are not call-saved.
3756
3757If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3758@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3759@end defmac
3760
3761@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3762
3763This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3764for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3765
3766If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3767@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3768@end defmac
3769
3770@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3771
3772Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3773is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3774Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3775column number to use instead.
3776
3777See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3778@end defmac
3779
3780@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3781
3782Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3783used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3784debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3785should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3786@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3787
3788@end defmac
3789
3790@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3791
3792Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3793that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3794should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3795.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3796return @code{@var{regno}}.
3797
3798@end defmac
3799
3800@node Elimination
3801@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3802
3803@c prevent bad page break with this line
3804This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3805
3806@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3807This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3808a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3809value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3810
3811This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3812according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3813constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3814to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3815Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3816pointer.
3817
3818In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3819without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3820automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3821@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3822them.
3823
3824In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3825register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3826fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3827
3828Default return value is @code{false}.
3829@end deftypefn
3830
3831@findex get_frame_size
3832@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3833A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3834between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3835the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3836such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3837registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3838
3839If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3840need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3841@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3842case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3843@end defmac
3844
3845@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3846If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3847eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3848defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3849references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3850
3851The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3852of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3853
3854On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3855the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3856must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3857replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3858depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3859
3860In this case, you might specify:
3861@smallexample
3862#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3863@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3864 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3865 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3866@end smallexample
3867
3868Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3869specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3870@end defmac
3871
3872@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3873This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3874try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3875@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3876is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3877preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3878knows about.
3879
3880Default return value is @code{true}.
3881@end deftypefn
3882
3883@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3884This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3885specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3886registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3887defined.
3888@end defmac
3889
3890@node Stack Arguments
3891@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3892@cindex arguments on stack
3893@cindex stack arguments
3894
3895The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3896on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3897control passing certain arguments in registers.
3898
3899@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3900This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3901prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3902passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3903cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3904The default is to not promote prototypes.
3905@end deftypefn
3906
3907@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3908A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3909outgoing arguments.
3910If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3911That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3912allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3913it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3914@end defmac
3915
3916@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3917A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3918last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3919defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3920and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3921@end defmac
3922
3923@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3924A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3925stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3926
3927On some machines, the definition
3928
3929@smallexample
3930#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3931@end smallexample
3932
3933@noindent
3934will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3935to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3936alignment. Then the definition should be
3937
3938@smallexample
3939#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3940@end smallexample
3941@end defmac
3942
3943@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3944@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3945A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3946will be computed and placed into the variable
3947@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3948onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3949increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3950
3951Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3952is not proper.
3953@end defmac
3954
3955@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3956Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3957allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3958registers.
3959
3960The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3961arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3962which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3963The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3964of the function.
3965
3966This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3967machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3968which.
3969@end defmac
3970@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3971@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3972
3973@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3974Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3975caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3976when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3977if the function called is a library function.
3978
3979If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3980whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3981@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3982@end defmac
3983
3984@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3985Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3986stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3987@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3988@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3989
3990Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3991stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3992suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3993stack in its natural location.
3994@end defmac
3995
893d13d5 3996@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3997This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3998a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3999and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
4000
4001@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
4002the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
4003@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
4004From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
4005
4006@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
4007describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
4008@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
4009From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
4010arguments (if known).
4011
4012When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
4013will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
4014you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
4015by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
4016a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
4017in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
4018
893d13d5 4019@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
4020stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
4021argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
4022
4023On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 4024of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
4025calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
4026the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
4027convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
4028arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
4029nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
4030@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
4031number of arguments.
4032@end deftypefn
4033
4034@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
4035A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4036pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4037when compiling a function call.
4038
4039@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4040have been accumulated.
4041
4042On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4043that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4044that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4045call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4046appropriate.
4047@end defmac
4048
4049@node Register Arguments
4050@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4051@cindex arguments in registers
4052@cindex registers arguments
4053
4054This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4055types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4056the stack.
4057
4058@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4059A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
4060in a register, and which register.
4061
4062The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
4063arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4064the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4065(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4066which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
4067correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
4068@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
4069occurred.
4070
4071The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
4072hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
4073argument on the stack.
4074
4075For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
4076pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
4077
4078The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4079used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4080@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4081@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4082describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4083@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4084register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4085register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4086second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4087the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4088As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4089RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4090argument is also stored on the stack.
4091
4092The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4093VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4094pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4095
4096@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4097The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4098where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4099nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4100by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4101
4102@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4103@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4104You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4105in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4106type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4107is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4108argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4109defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4110a register.
4111@end defmac
4112
4113@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4114This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4115solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4116definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4117documentation.
4118@end deftypefn
4119
4120@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4121Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4122that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4123necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4124argument.
4125
4126For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4127the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4128be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4129where the arguments will arrive.
4130
4131If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4132serves both purposes.
4133@end defmac
4134
4135@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4136This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4137argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4138arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4139pushed on the stack.
4140
4141On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4142registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4143first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4144on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4145structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4146in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4147compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4148
4149@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4150register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4151@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4152@end deftypefn
4153
ec9f85e5 4154@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4155This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4156position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4157predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4158passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4159
4160If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4161pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4162The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4163to that type.
4164@end deftypefn
4165
4166@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4167The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4168known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4169function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4170by the caller.
4171
4172For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4173determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4174not be generated.
4175
4176The default version of this hook always returns false.
4177@end deftypefn
4178
4179@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4180A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4181@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4182the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4183argument so far.
4184
4185There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4186arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4187variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4188arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4189@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4190should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4191@end defmac
4192
4193@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4194If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4195function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4196created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4197reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4198If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4199@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4200@end defmac
4201
4202@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4203A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4204@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4205variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4206is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4207the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4208For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4209declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4210@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4211being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4212arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4213parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4214@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4215
4216When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4217@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4218contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4219an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4220macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4221never both of them at once.
4222@end defmac
4223
4224@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4225Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4226it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4227@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4228is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
42290)} is used instead.
4230@end defmac
4231
4232@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4233Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4234finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4235undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4236
4237The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4238with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4239argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4240@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4241@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4242@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4243@end defmac
4244
4245@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4246A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4247@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4248values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4249Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4250the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4251
4252This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4253on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4254used for arguments without any special help.
4255@end defmac
4256
4257@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4258If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4259offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4260which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4261slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4262top.
4263@end defmac
4264
4265@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4266If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4267to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4268@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4269@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4270
4271The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4272multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4273it.
4274
4275This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4276For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4277big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4278constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4279@end defmac
4280
4281@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4282If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4283implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4284next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4285controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4286arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4287@end defmac
4288
4289@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4290Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4291memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4292macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4293machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4294@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4295registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4296a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4297required.
4298@end defmac
4299
4300@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4301If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4302of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4303@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4304@end defmac
4305
4306@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4307A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4308register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4309@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4310the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4311used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4312stack.
4313@end defmac
4314
4315@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4316This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4317as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4318arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4319to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4320AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4321registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4322point register.
4323
4324The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4325false.
4326@end deftypefn
4327
4328@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4329This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4330The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4331@end deftypefn
4332
07a5b2bc 4333@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4334This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4335to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4336variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4337to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4338variable.
07a5b2bc 4339The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4340this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4341internal type.
4342If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4343Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4344macro to iterate through all types.
4345@end deftypefn
4346
4347@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4348This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4349@var{fndecl}.
4350The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4351@end deftypefn
4352
4353@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4354This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4355type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4356@code{NULL_TREE}.
4357@end deftypefn
4358
4359@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4360This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4361@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4362arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4363@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4364@end deftypefn
4365
4366@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4367Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4368with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4369hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4370@end deftypefn
4371
4372@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4373Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4374insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4375considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4376must work.
4377
4378The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4379required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4380Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4381code in @file{optabs.c}.
4382@end deftypefn
4383
4384@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4385Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4386insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4387must have move patterns for this mode.
4388@end deftypefn
4389
4390@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4391Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4392small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4393@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4394in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4395In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4396for any mode.
4397
4398On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4399insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4400to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4401if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4402insn.
4403
4404Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4405in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4406the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4407classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4408registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4409registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4410SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4411strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4412machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4413
4414The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4415safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4416unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4417that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4418to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4419of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4420@end deftypefn
4421
4422@node Scalar Return
4423@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4424@cindex return values in registers
4425@cindex values, returned by functions
4426@cindex scalars, returned as values
4427
4428This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4429values---values that can fit in registers.
4430
4431@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4432
4433Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4434returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4435representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4436representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4437function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4438compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4439Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4440a function returns a value.
4441
4442On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4443(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4444place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4445@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4446The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4447multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4448@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4449location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4450the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4451that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4452port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4453@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4454
4455If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4456the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4457@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4458
4459If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4460node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4461pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4462convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4463known.
4464
4465Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4466which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4467the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4468different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4469
4470@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4471aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4472@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4473@end deftypefn
4474
4475@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4476This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4477a new target instead.
4478@end defmac
4479
4480@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4481A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4482function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4483
4484Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4485support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4486specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4487compiled.
4488@end defmac
4489
4490@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4491Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4492function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4493
4494The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4495library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4496representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4497
4498If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4499@end deftypefn
4500
4501@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4502A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4503register in which the values of called function may come back.
4504
4505A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4506second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4507recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4508suffices:
4509
4510@smallexample
4511#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4512@end smallexample
4513
4514If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4515function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4516should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4517
4518This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4519for a new target instead.
4520@end defmac
4521
4522@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4523A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4524register in which the values of called function may come back.
4525
4526A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4527second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4528recognized by this target hook.
4529
4530If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4531function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4532should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4533
4534If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4535@end deftypefn
4536
4537@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4538Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4539need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4540saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4541@end defmac
4542
4543@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4544This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4545at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4546padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4547is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4548
4549Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4550be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4551or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45524-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4553@code{SImode} rtx.
4554@end deftypefn
4555
4556@node Aggregate Return
4557@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4558@cindex aggregates as return values
4559@cindex large return values
4560@cindex returning aggregate values
4561@cindex structure value address
4562
4563When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4564cases), the value is not returned according to
4565@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4566caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4567should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4568address}.
4569
4570This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4571memory.
4572
4573@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4574This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4575function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4576Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4577will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4578libcalls.
4579
4580Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4581by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4582takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4583possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4584definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4585values, and 0 otherwise.
4586
4587Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4588be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4589to indicate this.
4590@end deftypefn
4591
4592@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4593Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4594in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4595only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4596If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4597and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4598target hook.
4599
4600If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4601@end defmac
4602
4603@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4604This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4605address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4606passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4607be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4608hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4609argument.
4610
4611On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4612is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4613caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4614be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4615@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4616the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4617the caller.
4618
4619If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4620stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4621@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4622structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4623to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4624@end deftypefn
4625
4626@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4627Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4628for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4629the address of a static variable containing the value.
4630
4631Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4632pass an address to the subroutine.
4633
4634This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4635nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4636@end defmac
4637
4638@node Caller Saves
4639@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4640
4641If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4642makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4643must live across calls.
4644
4645@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4646A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4647a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4648restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4649this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4650
4651If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4652machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4653@end defmac
4654
4655@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4656A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4657of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4658@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4659returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4660will select the smallest suitable mode.
4661@end defmac
4662
4663@node Function Entry
4664@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4665@cindex function entry and exit
4666@cindex prologue
4667@cindex epilogue
4668
4669This section describes the macros that output function entry
4670(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4671
4672@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4673If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4674function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4675initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4676saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4677local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4678stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4679
4680The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4681macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4682
4683@findex regs_ever_live
4684To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4685@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4686@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4687prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4688call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4689@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4690
4691On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4692not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4693they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4694appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4695registers are used in the function.
4696
4697@findex frame_pointer_needed
4698On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4699function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4700pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4701frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4702@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4703time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4704
4705The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4706required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4707listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4708order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4709stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4710the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4711for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4712compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4713or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4714need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4715@end deftypefn
4716
4717@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4718If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4719prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4720emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4721emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4722@end deftypefn
4723
4724@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4725If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4726epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4727emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4728emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4729@end deftypefn
4730
4731@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4732If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4733function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4734registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4735called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4736same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4737registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4738@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4739
4740On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4741of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4742instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4743@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4744
4745Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4746@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4747switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4748define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4749target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4750condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4751
4752On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4753function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4754two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4755is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4756@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4757a function that needs a frame pointer.
4758
4759Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4760@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4761The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4762function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4763
4764On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4765others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4766given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4767number of arguments.
4768
4769@findex current_function_pops_args
4770Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4771functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4772needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4773function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4774@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4775@end deftypefn
4776
4777@itemize @bullet
4778@item
4779@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4780A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4781uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4782stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4783if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4784arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4785yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4786region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4787registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4788features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4789
4790@item
4791An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4792The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4793the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4794machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4795in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4796a save area.
4797
4798@item
4799A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4800boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4801this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4802save area closer to the top of the stack.
4803
4804@item
4805@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4806Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4807@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4808argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4809@end itemize
4810
4811@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4812Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4813instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4814pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4815adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4816default is 0.
4817
4818Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4819frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4820stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4821compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4822@end defmac
4823
4824@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4825Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4826used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4827pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4828@end defmac
4829
4830@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4831Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4832used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4833on entry to an exception edge.
4834@end defmac
4835
4836@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4837Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4838instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4839definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4840representing the number of delay slots there.
4841@end defmac
4842
4843@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4844A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4845slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4846
4847The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4848being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4849eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4850of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4851If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4852may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4853(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4854slot.
4855
4856@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4857@findex final_scan_insn
4858The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4859list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4860@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4861delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4862@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4863outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4864@code{final_scan_insn}.
4865
4866You need not define this macro if you did not define
4867@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4868@end defmac
4869
4870@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4871A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4872function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4873inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4874adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4875the real function.
4876
4877First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4878contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4879contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4880in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4881e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4882all other incoming arguments.
4883
4884Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4885made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4886adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4887
4888@smallexample
4889p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4890@end smallexample
4891
4892After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4893@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4894not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4895return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4896
4897The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4898the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4899of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4900and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4901
4902The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4903have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4904some targets, but probably not.
4905
4906If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4907front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4908@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4909not support varargs.
4910@end deftypefn
4911
4912@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4913A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4914to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4915arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4916generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4917previously exposed.
4918@end deftypefn
4919
4920@node Profiling
4921@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4922@cindex profiling, code generation
4923
4924These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4925
4926@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4927A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4928assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4929
4930@findex mcount
4931The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4932your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4933compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4934compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4935
4936Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4937variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4938@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4939the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4940@end defmac
4941
4942@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4943A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4944code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4945not support profiling.
4946@end defmac
4947
4948@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4949Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4950@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4951allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4952implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4953@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4954@end defmac
4955
4956@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4957Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4958the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4959@end defmac
4960
4961@node Tail Calls
4962@subsection Permitting tail calls
4963@cindex tail calls
4964
4965@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4966True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4967call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4968or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4969
4970It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4971tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4972during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4973as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4974``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4975may vary greatly between different architectures.
4976@end deftypefn
4977
4978@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4979Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4980function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4981cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4982registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4983TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4984FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4985@end deftypefn
4986
4987@node Stack Smashing Protection
4988@subsection Stack smashing protection
4989@cindex stack smashing protection
4990
4991@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4992This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4993for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4994runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4995that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4996variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4997
4998The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4999@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5000@end deftypefn
5001
5002@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
5003This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
5004stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5005involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5006
5007The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5008@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5009normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5010@end deftypefn
5011
7458026b
ILT
5012@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
5013
38f8b050
JR
5014@node Varargs
5015@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5016@cindex varargs implementation
5017
5018GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5019@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5020on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5021varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5022conditionals to include it.
5023
5024ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5025the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5026implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5027to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5028@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5029supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5030
5031However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5032the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5033below.
5034
5035@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5036Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5037that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5038versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5039you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5040
5041On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5042control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5043other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5044found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5045
5046Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5047beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5048@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5049This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5050to use them for its own purposes.
5051@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5052@c 10feb93
5053@end defmac
5054
38f8b050 5055@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 5056This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
5057argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5058returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5059argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5060fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5061verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5062of the current function.
5063@end defmac
5064
5065@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5066Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5067passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5068has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5069specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5070with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5071
5072@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5073considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5074kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5075
5076The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5077interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5078@end defmac
5079
5080These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5081
5082@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5083If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5084@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5085beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5086return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5087to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5088@end deftypefn
5089
5090@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5091This target hook offers an alternative to using
5092@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5093@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5094register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5095have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5096use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5097pass all their arguments on the stack.
5098
5099The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5100structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5101named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5102last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5103
5104The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5105argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5106store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5107variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5108store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5109frame.
5110
5111Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5112compile time without knowing their data types,
5113@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5114have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5115for all data types.
5116
5117If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5118arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5119happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5120end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5121not generate any instructions in this case.
5122@end deftypefn
5123
5124@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5125Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5126argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5127
5128This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5129is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5130@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5131arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5132but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5133then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5134except the last are treated as named.
5135
5136You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5137@end deftypefn
5138
5139@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5140If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5141@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5142@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5143defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5144@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5145Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5146@end deftypefn
5147
5148@node Trampolines
5149@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5150@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5151@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5152
5153A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5154when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5155the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5156tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5157trampoline.
5158
5159The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5160address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5161the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5162two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5163exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5164machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5165two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5166operands.
5167
5168The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5169parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5170immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5171simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5172proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5173may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5174separately.
5175
5176@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5177This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5178on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5179the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5180label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5181
5182If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5183for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5184code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5185to generate it on the spot.
5186@end deftypefn
5187
5188@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5189Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5190(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5191@end defmac
5192
5193@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5194A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5195@end defmac
5196
5197@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5198Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5199
5200If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5201is used for aligning trampolines.
5202@end defmac
5203
5204@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5205This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5206@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5207is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5208RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5209when it is called.
5210
5211If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5212first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5213from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5214Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5215trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5216to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5217
5218If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5219enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5220initializing the trampoline proper.
5221@end deftypefn
5222
5223@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5224This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5225the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5226memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5227the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5228address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5229be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5230If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5231@end deftypefn
5232
5233Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5234separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5235fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5236jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5237
5238Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5239the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5240make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5241subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5242latter makes initialization faster.
5243
5244To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5245the following macro.
5246
5247@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5248If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5249cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5250typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5251@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5252@end defmac
5253
5254The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5255before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5256the following macro.
5257
5258@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5259Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5260code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5261file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5262named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5263emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5264@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5265@end defmac
5266
5267To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5268you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5269cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5270beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5271its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5272
5273@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5274Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5275work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5276which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5277@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5278
5279If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5280C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5281special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5282statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5283global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5284special assembler code.
5285@end defmac
5286
5287@node Library Calls
5288@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5289@cindex library subroutine names
5290@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5291
5292@c prevent bad page break with this line
5293Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5294
5295@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5296This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5297expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5298provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5299are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5300@end defmac
5301
5302@findex set_optab_libfunc
5303@findex init_one_libfunc
5304@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5305This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5306existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5307@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5308@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5309library routines.
5310
5311The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5312@end deftypefn
5313
5314@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5315This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5316implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5317mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5318return a tristate.
5319
5320GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5321comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5322don't need to define this macro.
5323@end defmac
5324
5325@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5326This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5327functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5328operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5329and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5330If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5331@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5332in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5333@end defmac
5334
5335@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5336@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5337@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5338@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5339@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5340Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5341library to provide floating point emulation.
5342
5343In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5344@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5345else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5346in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5347architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5348an example.
5349
5350If this macro is defined, the
5351@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5352false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5353@end defmac
5354
5355@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5356@findex matherr
5357@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5358The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5359expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5360deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5361@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5362system.
5363
5364If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5365domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5366error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5367there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5368that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5369@end defmac
5370
5371@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5372@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5373Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5374refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5375@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5376macro, a reasonable default is used.
5377@end defmac
5378
5379@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5380@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5381When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5382@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5383default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5384functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5385systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5386@end defmac
5387
5388@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5389@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5390When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5391and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5392default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5393@smallexample
5394void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5395void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5396void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5397@end smallexample
5398@end defmac
5399
5400@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5401Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5402the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5403involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5404at once to the method-lookup library function.
5405
5406The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5407to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5408@end defmac
5409
5410@node Addressing Modes
5411@section Addressing Modes
5412@cindex addressing modes
5413
5414@c prevent bad page break with this line
5415This is about addressing modes.
5416
5417@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5418@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5419@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5420@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5421A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5422pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5423@end defmac
5424
5425@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5426@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5427A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5428post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5429the size of the memory operand.
5430@end defmac
5431
5432@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5433@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5434A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5435post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5436@end defmac
5437
5438@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5439A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5440is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5441@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5442is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5443constant addresses are supported.
5444@end defmac
5445
5446@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5447@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5448accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5449known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5450expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5451@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5452@end defmac
5453
5454@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5455A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5456memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5457the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5458accept.
5459@end defmac
5460
5461@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5462A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5463address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5464
5465Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5466non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5467desired by the caller.
5468
5469The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5470that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5471considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5472kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5473must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5474up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5475register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5476if the array holds @code{-1}.
5477
5478The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5479accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5480register is required.
5481
5482Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5483and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5484constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5485specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5486recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5487
5488Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5489sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5490@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5491naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5492be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5493
5494@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5495On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5496the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5497target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5498into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5499@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5500@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5501Format}.
5502
5503@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5504Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5505this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5506has this syntax:
5507
5508@example
5509#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5510@end example
5511
5512@noindent
5513and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5514address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5515Whether the strict or non-strict variants are desired is defined by
5516the @code{REG_OK_STRICT} macro introduced earlier in this section.
5517Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5518files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5519@end deftypefn
5520
5521@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5522A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5523character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5524letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5525@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5526support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5527semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5528preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5529@code{'m'} constraint.
5530@end defmac
5531
5532@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5533A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5534or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5535can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5536@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5537
5538It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5539that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5540
5541The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5542a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5543@end defmac
5544
5545@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5546This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5547operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5548address.
5549
5550@findex break_out_memory_refs
5551@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5552and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5553@var{x}.
5554
5555The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5556@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5557should return the new @var{x}.
5558
5559It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5560The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5561is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5562a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5563strategy can generate better code.
5564@end deftypefn
5565
5566@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5567A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5568that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5569@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5570It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5571performance reasons.
5572
5573For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5574reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5575registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5576processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5577needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5578@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5579generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5580be shared.
5581
5582@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5583to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5584and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5585of reload internals.
5586
5587@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5588previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5589then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5590
5591@findex push_reload
5592The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5593need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5594suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5595
5596The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5597@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5598should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5599This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5600@code{push_reload}.
5601
5602@findex strict_memory_address_p
5603The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5604the address has become legitimate.
5605
5606@findex copy_rtx
5607If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5608this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5609single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5610top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5611It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5612address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5613@end defmac
5614
5615@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5616This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5617different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5618reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5619but not others.
5620
5621Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5622effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5623of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5624addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5625
5626You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5627
5628The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5629@end deftypefn
5630
5631@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5632A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5633@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5634different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5635reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5636but not others.
5637
5638Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5639effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5640of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5641addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5642
5643You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5644
5645These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5646@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5647@end defmac
5648
5649@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5650A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5651an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5652@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5653@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5654anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5655@end defmac
5656
5657@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5658This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5659@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5660macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5661references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5662addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5663the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5664into their original form.
5665@end deftypefn
5666
5667@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5668This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5669should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5670this hook returns false.
5671
5672The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5673deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5674from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5675holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5676of TLS symbols for various targets.
5677@end deftypefn
5678
5679@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5680This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5681be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5682of @var{x}.
5683
5684The default version returns false for all constants.
5685@end deftypefn
5686
89356d17 5687@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5688This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5689the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5690@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5691when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5692@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5693of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5694function are valid.
5695@end deftypefn
5696
5697@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5698This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5699address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5700used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5701@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5702
5703The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5704@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5705the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5706@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5707two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5708@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5709the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5710from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5711@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5712@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5713@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5714
5715If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5716to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5717use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5718@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5719should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5720described above.
5721If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5722the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5723log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5724@end deftypefn
5725
5726@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5727This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5728widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5729
5730If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5731@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5732widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5733preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5734@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5735@end deftypefn
5736
5737@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5738This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5739widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5740
5741If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5742@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5743widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5744preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5745@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5746@end deftypefn
5747
5748@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5749Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5750For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5751misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5752@end deftypefn
5753
5754@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5755Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5756@end deftypefn
5757
5758@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5759Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5760@end deftypefn
5761
5762@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5763Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5764@end deftypefn
5765
5766@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5767This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5768input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5769The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5770specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5771(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5772
5773If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5774@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5775conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5776@end deftypefn
5777
5778@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5779This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5780vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5781@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5782The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5783return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5784@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5785@end deftypefn
5786
5787@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5788This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5789store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5790parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5791the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5792parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5793@end deftypefn
5794
cc4b5170
RG
5795@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5796This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5797mode @var{mode}. The default is
5798equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5799transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5800@end deftypefn
5801
767f865f
RG
5802@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5803This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5804after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5805mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5806The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5807@end deftypefn
5808
38f8b050
JR
5809@node Anchored Addresses
5810@section Anchored Addresses
5811@cindex anchored addresses
5812@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5813
5814GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5815For example, if we have:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818static int a, b, c;
5819int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5820@end smallexample
5821
5822the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5823addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5824it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5825the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5826be something like:
5827
5828@smallexample
5829int foo (void)
5830@{
5831 register int *xr = &x;
5832 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5833@}
5834@end smallexample
5835
5836(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5837``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5838
5839The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5840in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5841section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5842or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5843
5844@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5845The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5846On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5847applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5848for every mode. The default value is 0.
5849@end deftypevr
5850
5851@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5852Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5853offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5854value is 0.
5855@end deftypevr
5856
5857@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5858Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5859@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5860The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5861of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5862
5863If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5864it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5865If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5866is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5867@end deftypefn
5868
5869@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5870Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5871@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5872@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5873
5874The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5875intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5876or target-specific sections.
5877@end deftypefn
5878
5879@node Condition Code
5880@section Condition Code Status
5881@cindex condition code status
5882
5883The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5884two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5885
5886The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5887(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5888clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5889register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5890architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5891most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5892most RISC machines.
5893
5894The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5895the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5896insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5897optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5898is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5899three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5900scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5901separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5902
5903For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5904represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5905condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5906condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5907or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5908Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5909that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5910
5911Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5912specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5913interested in most macros in this section.
5914
5915@menu
5916* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5917* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5918* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5919@end menu
5920
5921@node CC0 Condition Codes
5922@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5923@findex cc0
5924
5925@findex cc_status
5926The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5927describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5928the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5929variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5930currently based, and several standard flags.
5931
5932Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5933description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5934information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5935
5936@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5937C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5938component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5939
5940This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5941@end defmac
5942
5943@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5944A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5945The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5946the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5947define this macro to initialize it.
5948
5949This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5950@end defmac
5951
5952@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5953A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5954appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5955this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5956code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5957set @code{(cc0)}.
5958
5959This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5960
5961If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5962other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5963invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5964reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5965registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5966@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5967insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5968based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5969value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5970this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5971@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5972@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5973condition code value.
5974
5975The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5976with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5977@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5978constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5979insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5980@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5981@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5982
5983A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5984that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5985@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5986two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5987@end defmac
5988
5989@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5990@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5991@findex CCmode
5992@findex MODE_CC
5993
5994@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5995On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5996than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5997code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5998when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5999bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6000branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6001this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6002record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6003also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6004unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6005
6006If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6007@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6008a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6009have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6010by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6011be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6012the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6013
6014@smallexample
6015(define_insn ""
6016 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6017 (compare:CC_NOOV
6018 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6019 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6020 (const_int 0)))]
6021 ""
6022 "@dots{}")
6023@end smallexample
6024
6025@noindent
6026together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6027for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6028
6029@smallexample
6030#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6031 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6032 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6033 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6034 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6035 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6036@end smallexample
6037
6038Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6039were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6040this section.
6041
6042You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6043in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6044@end defmac
6045
6046@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6047On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6048convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6049does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6050comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6051
6052On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6053required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6054and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6055comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6056@var{op1} as required.
6057
6058GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6059valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6060@file{md} file.
6061
6062You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6063code or operands.
6064@end defmac
6065
6066@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6067A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6068comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6069can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6070then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6071
6072You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6073floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6074For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6075inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6076
6077@smallexample
6078#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6079@end smallexample
6080@end defmac
6081
6082@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6083A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6084comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6085@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6086machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6087instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6088freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6089like:
6090
6091@smallexample
6092#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6093 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6094 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6095@end smallexample
6096@end defmac
6097
6098@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6099On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6100register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6101regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6102hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6103small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6104to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6105arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6106When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6107integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6108@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6109
6110The default version of this hook returns false.
6111@end deftypefn
6112
6113@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6114On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6115@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6116validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6117target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6118both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6119return @code{VOIDmode}.
6120
6121The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6122same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6123returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6124@end deftypefn
6125
6126@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6127@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6128@findex conditional execution
6129@findex predication
6130
6131There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6132supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6133represent conditional branches.
6134
6135@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6136A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6137@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6138versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6139predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6140that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6141If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6142
6143@smallexample
6144#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6145 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6146@end smallexample
6147@end defmac
6148
6149@node Costs
6150@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6151@cindex costs of instructions
6152@cindex relative costs
6153@cindex speed of instructions
6154
6155These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6156on the target machine.
6157
6158@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6159A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6160register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6161expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6162value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6163that.
6164
6165It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6166same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6167registers if they are not general registers.
6168
6169If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6170hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6171classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6172constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6173allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6174if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6175
6176These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6177@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6178@end defmac
6179
6180@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6181This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6182from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6183are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6184A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6185that.
6186
6187It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6188same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6189registers if they are not general registers.
6190
6191If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6192hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6193classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6194constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6195allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6196if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6197
6198The default version of this function returns 2.
6199@end deftypefn
6200
6201@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6202A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6203register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6204is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6205is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6206registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6207should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6208
6209If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6210the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6211needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6212between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6213more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6214reflect the actual cost of the move.
6215
6216GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6217secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6218a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6219secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62204 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6221value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6222are the same as to this macro.
6223
6224These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6225@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6226@end defmac
6227
911852ff 6228@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6229This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6230between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6231if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6232This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6233If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6234registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6235
6236If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6237the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6238needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6239between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6240more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6241reflect the actual cost of the move.
6242
6243GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6244secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6245a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6246secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62474 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6248value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6249are the same as to this target hook.
6250@end deftypefn
6251
6252@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6253A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6254default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6255is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6256it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6257rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6258predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6259reduced then.
6260@end defmac
6261
6262Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6263but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6264ordinarily expect.
6265
6266@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6267Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6268than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6269faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6270require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6271between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6272
6273When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6274finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6275load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6276faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6277may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6278other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6279@end defmac
6280
6281@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6282Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6283@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6284than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6285handler.
6286
6287When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6288@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6289moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6290Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6291cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6292
6293If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6294this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6295@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6296@end defmac
6297
6298@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6299The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6300which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6301string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6302make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6303
6304Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6305@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6306the number of such sequences.
6307
6308The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6309optimized for speed rather than size.
6310
6311If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6312@end defmac
6313
6314@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6315A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6316copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6317will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6318than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6319@end defmac
6320
6321@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6322A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6323a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6324@end defmac
6325
6326@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6327The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6328of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6329or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6330eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6331
6332The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6333optimized for speed rather than size.
6334
6335If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6336@end defmac
6337
6338@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6339A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6340to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6341will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6342than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6343@end defmac
6344
6345@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6346The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6347of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6348a block set insn or a library call.
6349Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6350eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6351
6352The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6353optimized for speed rather than size.
6354
6355If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6356@end defmac
6357
6358@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6359A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6360used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6361other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6362storing values other than constant zero.
6363Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6364than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6365@end defmac
6366
6367@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6368A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6369used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6370other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6371called with a constant source string.
6372Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6373than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6374@end defmac
6375
6376@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6377A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6378thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6379@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6380@end defmac
6381
6382@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6383A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6384thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6385@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6386@end defmac
6387
6388@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6389A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6390thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6391@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6392@end defmac
6393
6394@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6395A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6396thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6397@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6398@end defmac
6399
6400@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6401A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6402thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6403@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6404@end defmac
6405
6406@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6407A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6408thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6409@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6410@end defmac
6411
6412@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6413This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6414thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6415@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6416@end defmac
6417
6418@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6419This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6420thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6421@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6422@end defmac
6423
6424@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6425Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6426function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6427@end defmac
6428
6429@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6430Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6431@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6432@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6433@end defmac
6434
6435@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6436This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6437
6438The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6439available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6440in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6441expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6442@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6443
6444In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6445@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6446instructions.
6447
6448On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6449for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6450necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6451for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6452operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6453
6454When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6455false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6456size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6457
6458The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6459processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6460@end deftypefn
6461
6462@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6463This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6464@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6465the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6466
6467For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6468true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6469instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6470all addresses will have equal costs.
6471
6472In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6473the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6474cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6475
6476For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6477and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6478is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6479references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6480the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6481that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6482instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6483specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6484
6485This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6486
6487On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6488cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6489@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6490be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6491@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6492should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6493should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6494registers on machines with lots of registers.
6495@end deftypefn
6496
6497@node Scheduling
6498@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6499
6500The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6501adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6502hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6503them: try the first ones in this list first.
6504
6505@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6506This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6507issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6508Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6509an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6510constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6511hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6512This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6513it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6514@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6515@end deftypefn
6516
6517@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6518This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6519from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6520still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6521@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6522@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6523You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6524than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6525@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6526debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6527@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6528was scheduled.
6529@end deftypefn
6530
6531@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6532This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6533relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6534dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6535is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6536to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6537that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6538data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6539description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6540output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6541times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6542acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6543@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6544@end deftypefn
6545
6546@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6547This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6548@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6549execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6550later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6551scheduling priorities of insns.
6552@end deftypefn
6553
6554@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6555This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6556list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6557combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6558@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6559debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6560@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6561list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6562a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6563reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6564@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6565is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6566the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6567can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6568@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6569@end deftypefn
6570
6571@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6572Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6573function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6574is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6575@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6576return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6577this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6578scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6579cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6580@end deftypefn
6581
6582@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6583This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6584chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6585correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6586example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6587analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6588dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6589calculated.
6590@end deftypefn
6591
6592@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6593This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6594instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6595pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6596is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6597@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6598region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6599scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6600@end deftypefn
6601
6602@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6603This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6604instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6605cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6606is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6607to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6608@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6609@end deftypefn
6610
6611@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6612This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6613@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6614@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6615@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6619This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6620@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6621@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6622@end deftypefn
6623
6624@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6625The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6626pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6627when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6628simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6629processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6630based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6631when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6632@end deftypefn
6633
6634@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6635The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6636@end deftypefn
6637
6638@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6639The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6640to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6641simulated processor cycle finishes.
6642@end deftypefn
6643
6644@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6645The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6646used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6647@end deftypefn
6648
6649@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6650The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6651The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6652to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6653state on a single insn is not enough.
6654@end deftypefn
6655
6656@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6657The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6658The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6659to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6660state on a single insn is not enough.
6661@end deftypefn
6662
6663@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6664This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6665for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6666chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6667value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6668@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6669subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6670maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6671@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6672packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6673rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6674
6675This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6676processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6677with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6678@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6679@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6680processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6681@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6682until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6683the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6684
6685Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6686pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6687schedules to choose the best one.
6688
6689The default is no multipass scheduling.
6690@end deftypefn
6691
6692@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6693
6694This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6695considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6696zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6697be issued.
6698
6699The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6700@end deftypefn
6701
c06bbdf7 6702@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6703This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6704on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6705@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6706the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6707is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6708start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6709verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6710@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6711processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6712and the current processor cycle.
6713@end deftypefn
6714
6715@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6716This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6717the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6718are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6719to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6720being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6721dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6722parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6723The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6724insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6725and @code{false} otherwise.
6726
6727Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6728where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6729delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6730that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6731important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6732closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6733not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6734@end deftypefn
6735
6736@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6737This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6738the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6739per instruction data structures.
6740@end deftypefn
6741
6742@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6743Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6744@end deftypefn
6745
6746@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6747Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6748It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6749beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6750@end deftypefn
6751
6752@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6753Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6754@end deftypefn
6755
6756@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6757Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6758@end deftypefn
6759
6760@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6761Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6762@end deftypefn
6763
6764@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6765This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6766speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6767The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6768version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6769pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6770or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6771speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6772the generated speculative pattern.
6773@end deftypefn
6774
6775@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6776This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6777for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6778instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6779@end deftypefn
6780
6781@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6782This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6783check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6784speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6785@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6786be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6787recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6788a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6789@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6790@end deftypefn
6791
6792@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6793This hook is used as a workaround for
6794@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6795called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6796discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6797being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6798@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6799For non-speculative instructions,
6800the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6801the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6802is nearly full.
6803@end deftypefn
6804
6805@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6806This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6807enabled/used.
6808The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6809The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6810@end deftypefn
6811
6812@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6813This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6814resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6815the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6816backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6817bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6818of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6819@end deftypefn
6820
7942e47e
RY
6821@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6822This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6823is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6824@end deftypefn
6825
6826@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6827This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6828in its second parameter.
6829@end deftypefn
6830
38f8b050
JR
6831@node Sections
6832@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6833@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6834@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6835
6836An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6837data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6838section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6839section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6840section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6841of sections.
6842
6843@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6844@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6845The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6846is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6847as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6848initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6849They may however depend on command-line flags.
6850
6851@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6852use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6853to be string literals.
6854
6855Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6856section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6857should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6858@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6859
6860You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6861@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6862in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6863@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6864create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6865reuse @code{text_section}.
6866
6867All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6868if the target does not provide them.
6869
6870@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6871A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6872assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6873Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6874@end defmac
6875
6876@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6877If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6878frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6879a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6880@end defmac
6881
6882@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6883If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6884executed functions in the program.
6885@end defmac
6886
6887@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6888A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6889assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6890data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6891@end defmac
6892
6893@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6894If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6895containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6896initialized, writable small data.
6897@end defmac
6898
6899@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6900A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6901assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6902data.
6903@end defmac
6904
6905@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6906If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6907containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6908uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6909@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6910uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6911@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6912used.
6913@end defmac
6914
6915@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6916If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6917containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6918uninitialized, writable small data.
6919@end defmac
6920
6921@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6922If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6923assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6924common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6925@end defmac
6926
6927@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6928If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6929containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6930default is @code{'T'}.
6931@end defmac
6932
6933@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6934If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6935containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6936initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6937not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6938variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6939@end defmac
6940
6941@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6942If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6943containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6944finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6945not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6946variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6947@end defmac
6948
6949@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6950If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6951containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6952part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6953defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6954both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6955@end defmac
6956
6957@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6958If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6959containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6960part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6961defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6962both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6963@end defmac
6964
6965@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6966If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6967via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6968the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6969@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6970to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6971sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6972ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6973registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6974constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6975@end defmac
6976
6977@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6978If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6979variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6980when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6981you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6982they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6983expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6984MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6985require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6986to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6987access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6988@end defmac
6989
6990@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6991If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6992arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6993@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6994and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6995@end defmac
6996
6997@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6998Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6999tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7000section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7001readonly data section is used.
7002
7003This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7004@end defmac
7005
7006@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
7007Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7008@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7009of its own that you need to create.
7010
7011GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7012any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7013described below.
7014@end deftypefn
7015
7016@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
7017Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7018selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7019should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7020local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7021
7022The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7023is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7024when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7025in read-only sections even in executables.
7026@end deftypefn
7027
7028@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
7029Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7030assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7031some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7032requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7033local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7034@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7035
7036The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7037variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7038
7039See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7040@end deftypefn
7041
7042@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7043Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7044for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7045
7046In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7047function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7048it is unlikely to be called.
7049@end defmac
7050
7051@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
7052Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7053and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7054As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7055the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7056
7057The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7058ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7059example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7060Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7061@end deftypefn
7062
7063@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7064Return the readonly data section associated with
7065@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7066The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7067the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7068if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7069otherwise.
7070@end deftypefn
7071
7072@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7073Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7074should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7075constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7076case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7077in bits.
7078
7079The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7080constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7081else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7082@end deftypefn
7083
7084@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7085Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7086by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7087the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7088or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7089hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7090your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7091returns the @var{id} provided.
7092@end deftypefn
7093
7094@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7095Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7096treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7097function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7098
7099The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7100@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7101an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7102rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7103in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7104
7105In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7106a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7107will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7108register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7109rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7110leave it alone.)
7111
7112The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7113that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7114be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7115declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7116declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7117@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7118
7119@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7120The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7121@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7122Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7123encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7124discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7125
7126The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7127in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7128@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7129before overriding it.
7130@end deftypefn
7131
7132@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7133Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7134the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7135may have added.
7136@end deftypefn
7137
7138@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7139Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7140The default version of this hook always returns false.
7141@end deftypefn
7142
7143@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7144Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7145``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7146@end deftypevr
7147
3c5273a9
KT
7148@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7149
38f8b050
JR
7150@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7151Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7152rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7153or executable image).
7154
7155The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7156for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7157currently supported object file formats.
7158@end deftypefn
7159
7160@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7161Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7162The default value is false.
7163@end deftypevr
7164
7165
7166@node PIC
7167@section Position Independent Code
7168@cindex position independent code
7169@cindex PIC
7170
7171This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7172independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7173generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7174@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7175@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7176must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7177when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7178need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7179relative addresses.
7180@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7181@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7182
7183@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7184The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7185data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7186processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7187is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7188pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7189is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7190necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7191when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7192@end defmac
7193
7194@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7195A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7196@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7197the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7198this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7199@end defmac
7200
7201@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7202A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7203operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7204You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7205check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7206check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7207(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7208position independent code.
7209@end defmac
7210
7211@node Assembler Format
7212@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7213
7214This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7215to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7216instructions do.
7217
7218@menu
7219* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7220* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7221* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7222* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7223* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7224 and termination routines.
7225* Macros for Initialization::
7226 Specific macros that control the handling of
7227 initialization and termination routines.
7228* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7229* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7230* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7231* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7232@end menu
7233
7234@node File Framework
7235@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7236@cindex assembler format
7237@cindex output of assembler code
7238
7239@c prevent bad page break with this line
7240This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7241
7242@findex default_file_start
7243@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7244Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7245find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7246by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7247quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7248@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7249lets other target files rely on these variables.
7250@end deftypefn
7251
7252@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7253If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7254printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7255@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7256to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7257definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7258assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7259whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7260
7261The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7262verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7263comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7264@end deftypevr
7265
7266@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7267If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7268for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7269@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7270this to be done. The default is false.
7271@end deftypevr
7272
7273@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7274Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7275to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7276@end deftypefn
7277
7278@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7279Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7280special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7281the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7282should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7283need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7284this function.
7285@end deftypefun
7286
7287@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7288Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7289to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7290nothing.
7291@end deftypefn
7292
7293@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7294Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7295to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7296nothing.
7297@end deftypefn
7298
7299@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7300Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7301unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7302here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7303because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7304nothing.
7305@end deftypefn
7306
7307@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7308A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7309assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7310the end of the line.
7311@end defmac
7312
7313@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7314A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7315statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7316@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7317assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7318that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7319@end defmac
7320
7321@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7322A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7323statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7324@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7325time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7326@end defmac
7327
7328@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7329A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7330which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7331the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7332
7333This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7334for the file format in use is appropriate.
7335@end defmac
7336
b5f5d41d
AS
7337@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7338
38f8b050
JR
7339@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7340A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7341@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7342in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7343the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7344of the filename using this macro.
7345@end defmac
7346
7347@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7348A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7349@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7350macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7351@end defmac
7352
7353@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7354Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7355should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7356of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7357is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7358this section is associated.
7359@end deftypefn
7360
7361@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7362This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7363@end deftypevr
7364
7365@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7366@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7367This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7368section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7369This is true on most ELF targets.
7370@end deftypevr
7371
7372@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7373Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7374based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7375declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7376null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7377
7378The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7379read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7380need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7381set via @code{__attribute__}.
7382@end deftypefn
7383
7384@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7385Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7386switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7387enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7388It can take the following values:
7389
7390@table @gcctabopt
7391@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7392@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7393
7394@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7395@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7396direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7397default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7398command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7399various different individual optimization passes.
7400
7401@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7402@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7403ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7404target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7405time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7406warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7407wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7408necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7409perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7410switches.
7411
7412@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7413This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7414
7415@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7416This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7417@end table
7418
7419The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7420supported in the future.
7421
7422By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7423provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7424it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7425section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7426provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7427hook.
7428@end deftypefn
7429
7430@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7431This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7432ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7433hook.
7434@end deftypevr
7435
7436@need 2000
7437@node Data Output
7438@subsection Output of Data
7439
7440
7441@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7442@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7443@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7444@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7445@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7446@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7447@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7448@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7449@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7450These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7451of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7452byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7453aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7454@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7455
7456The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7457followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7458the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7459@end deftypevr
7460
7461@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7462The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7463integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7464in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7465function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7466object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7467split the object into smaller parts.
7468
7469The default implementation of this hook will use the
7470@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7471when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7472@end deftypefn
7473
6cbd8875
AS
7474@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7475A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7476can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7477the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7478@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7479
7480If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7481so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7482itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7483return @code{true}.
7484@end deftypefn
7485
38f8b050
JR
7486@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7487A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7488@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7489@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7490allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7491
7492If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7493@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7494prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7495@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7496@end defmac
7497
7498@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7499A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7500instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7501bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7502@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7503
7504If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7505Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7506@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7507@end defmac
7508
7509@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7510A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7511@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7512is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7513@end defmac
7514
7515@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7516You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7517expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7518pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7519GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7520not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7521pool before the function.
7522@end defmac
7523
7524@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7525A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7526constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7527the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7528be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7529is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7530immediately after this call.
7531
7532If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7533not be defined.
7534@end defmac
7535
7536@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7537A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7538constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7539anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7540
7541The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7542assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7543output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7544@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7545@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7546alignment.
7547
7548The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7549the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7550responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7551Here is how to do this:
7552
7553@smallexample
7554@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7555@end smallexample
7556
7557When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7558@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7559entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7560
7561You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7562@end defmac
7563
7564@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7565A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7566pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7567function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7568obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7569constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7570
7571If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7572define this macro.
7573@end defmac
7574
7575@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7576Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7577used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7578to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7579a line separator uses multiple characters.
7580
7581If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7582the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7583@end defmac
7584
7585@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7586These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7587assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7588default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7589@end deftypevr
7590
7591These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7592of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7593
7594@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7595@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7596@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7597@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7598@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7599@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7600These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7601target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7602the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7603@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7604simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7605@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7606by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7607it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
760832 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7609on the host machine.
7610
7611The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7612using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7613machine's memory.
7614@end defmac
7615
7616@node Uninitialized Data
7617@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7618
7619Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7620outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7621
7622@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7623A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7624@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7625@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7626is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7627possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7628other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7629backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7630byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7631equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7632the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7633an ordinary undefined external.
7634
7635Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7636output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7637assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7638
7639This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7640common global variables are output.
7641@end defmac
7642
7643@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7644Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7645separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7646place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7647handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7648as the number of bits.
7649@end defmac
7650
7651@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7652Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7653variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7654is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7655in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7656@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7657the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7658@end defmac
7659
7660@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7661A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7662@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7663@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7664is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7665
7666Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7667defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7668@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7669before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7670the name, and a newline.
7671
7672There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7673this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7674The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7675switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7676You do not need to do both.
7677
7678Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7679non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7680efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7681not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7682common in order to save space in the object file.
7683@end defmac
7684
7685@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7686Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7687separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7688place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7689handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7690as the number of bits.
7691
7692Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7693@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7694@end defmac
7695
7696@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7697A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7698@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7699@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7700is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7701
7702Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7703output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7704assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7705
7706This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7707static variables are output.
7708@end defmac
7709
7710@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7711Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7712separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7713place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7714handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7715as the number of bits.
7716@end defmac
7717
7718@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7719Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7720variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7721is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7722in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7723@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7724the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7725@end defmac
7726
7727@node Label Output
7728@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7729
7730@c prevent bad page break with this line
7731This is about outputting labels.
7732
7733@findex assemble_name
7734@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7735A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7736@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7737Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7738output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7739assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7740definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7741@end defmac
7742
135a687e
KT
7743@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7744A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7745@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7746a function.
7747Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7748output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7749assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7750definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7751
7752If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7753usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7754@end defmac
7755
38f8b050
JR
7756@findex assemble_name_raw
7757@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7758Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7759to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7760@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7761that it is more efficient.
7762@end defmac
7763
7764@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7765A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7766size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7767default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7768systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7769
7770Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7771of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7772for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7773macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7774define this macro.
7775@end defmac
7776
7777@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7778A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7779@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7780symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7781If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7782provided.
7783@end defmac
7784
7785@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7786A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7787@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7788the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7789address.
7790
7791If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7792provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7793@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7794the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7795not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7796to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7797@end defmac
7798
7799@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7800A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7801type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7802default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7803systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7804
7805Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7806@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7807custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7808types at all, do not define this macro.
7809@end defmac
7810
7811@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7812A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7813the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7814default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7815the default is not to define this macro.
7816
7817Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7818@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7819custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7820types at all, do not define this macro.
7821@end defmac
7822
7823@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7824A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7825@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7826symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7827that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7828you should not count on this.
7829
7830If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7831definition of this macro is provided.
7832@end defmac
7833
7834@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7835A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7836@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7837function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7838outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7839@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7840@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7841
7842If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7843usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7844
7845You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7846of this macro.
7847@end defmac
7848
7849@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7850A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7851@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7852which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7853function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7854representing the function.
7855
7856If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7857
7858You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7859of this macro.
7860@end defmac
7861
7862@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7863A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7864@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7865initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7866label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7867@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7868
7869If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7870usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7871
7872You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7873@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7874@end defmac
7875
ad78130c 7876@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7877A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7878for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7879target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7880@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7881and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7882will be an internal label.
7883
7884The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7885usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7886
7887You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7888@end deftypefn
7889
7890@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7891A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7892@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7893for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7894
7895If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7896nothing.
7897@end defmac
7898
7899@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7900A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7901once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7902chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7903initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7904something about the size of the object.
7905
7906If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7907nothing.
7908
7909You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7910@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7911@end defmac
7912
7913@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7914This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7915@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7916that is, available for reference from other files.
7917
7918The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7919@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7920@end deftypefn
7921
7922@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7923This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7924@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7925global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7926
7927The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7928@end deftypefn
7929
7930@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7931A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7932@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7933that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7934no other definition is available. Use the expression
7935@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7936itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7937for making that name weak, and a newline.
7938
7939If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7940support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7941macro.
7942@end defmac
7943
7944@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7945Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7946@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7947or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7948should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7949defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7950@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7951to make @var{name} weak.
7952@end defmac
7953
7954@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7955Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7956symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7957declaration of @code{name}.
7958@end defmac
7959
7960@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7961A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7962supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7963
7964If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7965definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7966is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7967@end defmac
7968
7969@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7970A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7971
7972If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7973definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7974this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7975flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7976@end defmac
7977
7978@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7979A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7980public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7981be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7982format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7983section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7984requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7985@end defmac
7986
7987@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7988A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7989semantics.
7990
7991If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7992definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7993definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7994you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7995setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7996be emitted as one-only.
7997@end defmac
7998
7999@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
8000This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8001commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8002hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8003@end deftypefn
8004
8005@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8006A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8007that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8008The default is @code{0}.
8009
8010Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8011if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8012will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8013symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8014thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8015(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8016with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8017
8018The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8019targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8020restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8021table of contents.
8022@end defmac
8023
8024@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8025A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8026@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8027symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8028not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8029declaration.
8030
8031This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8032The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8033@end defmac
8034
8035@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
8036This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8037pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8038library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8039@end deftypefn
8040
8041@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
8042This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8043directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8044.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8045@end deftypefn
8046
8047@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8048A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8049@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8050@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8051is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8052systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8053@end defmac
8054
8055@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8056A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8057@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8058will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8059to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8060encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8061@end defmac
8062
8063@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8064A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8065result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8066@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8067This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8068specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8069when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8070being taken.
8071@end defmac
8072
8073@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8074A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8075name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8076
8077It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8078used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8079will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8080
8081It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8082object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8083should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8084beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8085convention your system uses, and follow it.
8086
8087The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8088@end deftypefn
8089
8090@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8091A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8092label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8093@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8094may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8095systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8096bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8097bundles.
8098
8099If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8100used.
8101@end defmac
8102
8103@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8104A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8105is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8106
8107This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8108produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8109with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8110
8111If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8112output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8113@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8114string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8115to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8116@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8117you should know what it does on your machine.)
8118@end defmac
8119
8120@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8121A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8122@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8123@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8124added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8125
8126The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8127produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8128@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8129assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8130macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8131internal static variables in different scopes.
8132
8133Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8134conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8135or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8136between the name and the number will suffice.
8137
8138If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8139which is correct for most systems.
8140@end defmac
8141
8142@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8143A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8144which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8145
8146@findex SET_ASM_OP
8147If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8148correct for most systems.
8149@end defmac
8150
8151@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8152A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8153which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8154to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8155be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8156the tree nodes are available.
8157
8158@findex SET_ASM_OP
8159If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8160correct for most systems.
8161@end defmac
8162
8163@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8164A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8165(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8166of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8167current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8168This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8169@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8170@end defmac
8171
8172@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8173A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8174which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8175@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8176an undefined weak symbol.
8177
8178Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8179@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8180@end defmac
8181
8182@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8183Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8184Objective-C methods.
8185
8186The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8187class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8188the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8189@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8190
8191These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8192the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8193systems define other ways of computing names.
8194
8195@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8196buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8197@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
819850 characters extra.
8199
8200The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8201method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8202@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8203in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8204
8205On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8206macro to provide more human-readable names.
8207@end defmac
8208
8209@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8210A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8211@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8212Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8213linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8214@end defmac
8215
8216@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8217A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8218@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8219unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8220whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8221@end defmac
8222
8223@node Initialization
8224@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8225@cindex initialization routines
8226@cindex termination routines
8227@cindex constructors, output of
8228@cindex destructors, output of
8229
8230The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8231(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8232data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8233to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8234@code{main} is called.
8235
8236Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8237@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8238terminates.
8239
8240To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8241must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8242be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8243system, you need to specify how to do this.
8244
8245There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8246initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8247Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8248
8249@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8250@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8251The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8252initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8253termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8254
8255Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82560, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8257the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8258pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8259pointer containing zero.
8260
8261Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8262@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8263time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8264list; destructors in forward order.
8265
8266The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8267formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8268aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8269Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8270object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8271the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8272accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8273Termination functions are handled similarly.
8274
8275This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8276@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8277support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8278constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8279and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8280
8281When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8282upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8283support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8284parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8285program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8286
8287@smallexample
8288ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8289@end smallexample
8290
8291The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8292section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8293for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8294files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8295are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8296
8297The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8298compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8299fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8300to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8301of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8302that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8303
8304To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8305macro properly.
8306
8307If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8308@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8309entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8310it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8311after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8312in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8313
8314In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8315two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8316and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8317@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8318entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8319and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8320code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8321the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8322placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8323a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8324@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8325section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8326the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8327the initialization process.
8328
8329The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8330This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8331file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8332this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8333termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8334an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8335pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8336the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8337initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8338via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8339@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8340
8341@ifinfo
8342The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8343customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8344@end ifinfo
8345
8346@node Macros for Initialization
8347@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8348
8349Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8350and termination functions:
8351
8352@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8353If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8354operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8355defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8356using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8357macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8358run the initialization functions.
8359@end defmac
8360
8361@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8362If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8363This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8364on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8365be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8366@end defmac
8367
8368@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8369If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8370the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8371@end defmac
8372
8373@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8374If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8375the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8376@end defmac
8377
8378@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8379If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8380automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8381should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8382the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8383function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8384
8385This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8386shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8387exception tables embedded in the code.
8388@end defmac
8389
8390@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8391If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8392automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8393should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8394the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8395function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8396@end defmac
8397
8398@defmac INVOKE__main
8399If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8400@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8401where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8402useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8403@end defmac
8404
8405@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8406If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8407compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8408of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8409encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8410@end defmac
8411
8412@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8413This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8414collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8415It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8416@end deftypevr
8417
8418@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8419If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8420the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8421
8422Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8423no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8424priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8425otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8426
8427If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8428be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8429target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8430is not defined.
8431@end deftypefn
8432
8433@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8434This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8435functions rather than initialization functions.
8436@end deftypefn
8437
8438If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8439generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8440
8441If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8442constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8443an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8444
8445On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8446@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8447
8448@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8449Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8450object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8451object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8452
8453This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8454part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8455@end defmac
8456
8457@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8458Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8459to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8460@command{nm}.
8461
8462If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8463dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8464these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8465termination functions in shared libraries:
8466@end defmac
8467
8468@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8469Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8470which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8471@end defmac
8472
8473@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8474Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8475of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8476of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8477from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8478code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8479line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8480@end defmac
8481
8482@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8483Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8484library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8485strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8486constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8487that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8488@end defmac
8489
8490@node Instruction Output
8491@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8492
8493@c prevent bad page break with this line
8494This describes assembler instruction output.
8495
8496@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8497A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8498registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8499register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8500@end defmac
8501
8502@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8503If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8504and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8505registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8506to registers using alternate names.
8507@end defmac
8508
8509@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8510Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8511requires different names for the machine instructions.
8512
8513The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8514assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8515macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8516points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8517written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8518opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8519increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8520so that it will not be output twice.
8521
8522In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8523name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8524that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8525care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8526@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8527
8528@findex recog_data.operand
8529If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8530elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8531
8532If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8533in the usual way.
8534@end defmac
8535
8536@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8537If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8538assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8539they will be output differently.
8540
8541Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8542extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8543elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8544The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8545template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8546by changing the contents of the vector.
8547
8548This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8549file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8550can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8551as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8552syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8553writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8554
8555If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8556@end defmac
8557
8558@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8559If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8560output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8561if necessary.
8562
8563Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8564extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8565elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8566The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8567template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8568by checking the contents of the vector.
8569@end deftypefn
8570
8571@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8572A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8573assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8574RTL expression.
8575
8576@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8577of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8578printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8579the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8580operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8581@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8582@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8583
8584@findex reg_names
8585If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8586The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8587@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8588@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8589
8590When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8591(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8592with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8593@var{code}.
8594@end defmac
8595
8596@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8597A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8598punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8599@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8600punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8601in this way.
8602@end defmac
8603
8604@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8605A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8606assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8607whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8608
8609@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8610On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8611section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8612@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8613@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8614Format}.
8615@end defmac
8616
8617@findex dbr_sequence_length
8618@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8619A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8620been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8621determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8622currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8623or whatever.
8624
8625Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8626reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8627explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8628@end defmac
8629
8630@findex final_sequence
8631Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8632prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8633(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8634found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8635processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8636being output.
8637
8638@findex asm_fprintf
8639@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8640@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8641@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8642@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8643If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8644@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8645@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8646support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8647files can define these macros differently.
8648@end defmac
8649
8650@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8651If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8652statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8653the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8654printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8655statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8656generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8657specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8658The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8659string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8660upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8661@end defmac
8662
8663@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8664If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8665different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8666numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8667first variant.
8668
8669If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8670@smallexample
8671@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8672@end smallexample
8673@noindent
8674in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8675first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8676@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8677@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8678within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8679alternatives within the braces than the value of
8680@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8681
8682If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8683@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8684operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8685
8686Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8687@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8688the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8689@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8690if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8691opcodes or operand order.
8692@end defmac
8693
8694@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8695A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8696which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8697The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8698profiling.
8699@end defmac
8700
8701@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8702A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8703which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8704The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8705profiling.
8706@end defmac
8707
8708@node Dispatch Tables
8709@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8710
8711@c prevent bad page break with this line
8712This concerns dispatch tables.
8713
8714@cindex dispatch table
8715@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8716A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8717pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8718@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8719definitions of these labels are output using
8720@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8721way here. For example,
8722
8723@smallexample
8724fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8725 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8726@end smallexample
8727
8728You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8729dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8730will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8731@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8732mode and flags can be read.
8733@end defmac
8734
8735@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8736This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8737in a dispatch table are absolute.
8738
8739The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8740@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8741a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8742definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8743For example,
8744
8745@smallexample
8746fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8747@end smallexample
8748@end defmac
8749
8750@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8751Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8752specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8753@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8754jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8755@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8756
8757This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8758for the table.
8759
8760If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8761@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8762@end defmac
8763
8764@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8765Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8766jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8767after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8768the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8769@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8770of the preceding label.
8771
8772If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8773the jump-table.
8774@end defmac
8775
8776@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8777This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8778should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8779should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8780function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8781The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8782exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8783true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8784
8785The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8786@end deftypefn
8787
8788@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8789This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8790It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8791to be broken up according to function.
8792
8793The default is that no label is emitted.
8794@end deftypefn
8795
a68b5e52
RH
8796@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8797
38f8b050
JR
8798@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8799This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8800given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8801returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8802@end deftypefn
8803
3bc6b3e6
RH
8804@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8805
38f8b050
JR
8806@node Exception Region Output
8807@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8808
8809@c prevent bad page break with this line
8810
8811This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8812region.
8813
8814@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8815If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8816exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8817provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8818@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8819
8820You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8821unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8822@end defmac
8823
8824@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8825If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8826data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8827might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8828collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8829
8830Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8831also defined.
8832@end defmac
8833
8834@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8835Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8836information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8837runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8838and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8839@end defmac
8840
8841@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8842An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8843that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8844@end defmac
8845
8846@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8847Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8848information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8849Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8850@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8851or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8852@end defmac
38f8b050 8853
f0a0390e
RH
8854@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8855This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8856by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8857should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8858@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8859should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8860information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8861
f0a0390e
RH
8862A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8863This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8864default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8865
f0a0390e
RH
8866Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8867not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8868setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8869macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8870depending on this setting.
8871
8872The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8873@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8874@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8875@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8876
8877@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8878This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8879tables even when exceptions are not used.
8880@end deftypevr
8881
8882@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8883This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8884runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8885determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8886so the target must provide it directly.
8887@end defmac
8888
8889@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8890Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8891should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8892instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8893@end defmac
8894
8895@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8896This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8897function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8898@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8899alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8900minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8901the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8902@end defmac
8903
8904@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8905Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8906end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8907Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8908true otherwise.
8909@end deftypevr
8910
8911@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8912Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8913represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8914register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8915locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8916register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8917If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8918@end deftypefn
8919
8920@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8921If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8922multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8923sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8924It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8925filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8926@var{address} is the address of the table.
8927@end deftypefn
8928
8929@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8930This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8931the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8932if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8933reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8934@end deftypefn
8935
8936@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8937This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8938based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8939the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8940running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8941@end deftypevr
8942
8943@node Alignment Output
8944@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8945
8946@c prevent bad page break with this line
8947This describes commands for alignment.
8948
8949@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8950The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8951a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8952
8953This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8954to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8955define the macro.
8956
8957Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8958to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8959@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8960selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8961@end defmac
8962
ad0c4c36
DD
8963@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8964The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8965@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8966@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8967@end deftypefn
8968
38f8b050
JR
8969@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8970The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8971a @code{BARRIER}.
8972
8973This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8974to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8975define the macro.
8976@end defmac
8977
ad0c4c36
DD
8978@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8979The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8980@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8981@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8982@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8983
8984@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8985The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8986a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8987
8988This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8989to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8990define the macro.
8991
8992Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8993to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8994@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8995selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8996@end defmac
8997
ad0c4c36
DD
8998@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8999The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9000@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9001defined.
9002@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
9003
9004@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9005The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9006If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9007the maximum of the specified values is used.
9008
9009Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9010to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9011@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9012selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9013@end defmac
9014
ad0c4c36
DD
9015@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
9016The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9017to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9018is defined.
9019@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
9020
9021@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9022A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9023instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9024Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9025expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9026@end defmac
9027
9028@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9029Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9030text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9031This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9032produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9033section.
9034@end defmac
9035
9036@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9037A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9038command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9039@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9040@end defmac
9041
9042@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9043Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9044for padding, if necessary.
9045@end defmac
9046
9047@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9048A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9049command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9050@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9051satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9052a C expression of type @code{int}.
9053@end defmac
9054
9055@need 3000
9056@node Debugging Info
9057@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9058
9059@c prevent bad page break with this line
9060This describes how to specify debugging information.
9061
9062@menu
9063* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9064* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9065* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9066* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9067* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9068* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9069@end menu
9070
9071@node All Debuggers
9072@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9073
9074@c prevent bad page break with this line
9075These macros affect all debugging formats.
9076
9077@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9078A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9079register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9080of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9081some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9082versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9083compiler and another for DBX@.
9084
9085If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9086used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9087consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9088Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9089expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9090
9091If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9092does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9093redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9094@end defmac
9095
9096@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9097A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9098variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9099computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9100gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9101that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9102for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9103@option{-g} options is used.
9104@end defmac
9105
9106@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9107A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9108having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9109@var{offset}.
9110@end defmac
9111
9112@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9113A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9114produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9115this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9116debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9117@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9118@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9119
9120When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9121value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9122exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9123value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9124defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9125
9126The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9127user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9128@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9129@end defmac
9130
9131@node DBX Options
9132@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9133
9134@c prevent bad page break with this line
9135These are specific options for DBX output.
9136
9137@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9138Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9139in response to the @option{-g} option.
9140@end defmac
9141
9142@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9143Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9144in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9145@end defmac
9146
9147@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9148Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9149GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9150debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9151macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9152if there is any occasion to.
9153@end defmac
9154
9155@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9156Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9157in the text section.
9158@end defmac
9159
9160@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9161A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9162use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9163If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9164applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9165@end defmac
9166
9167@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9168A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9169use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9170value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9171@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9172information format.
9173@end defmac
9174
9175@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9176A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9177use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9178name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9179macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9180@end defmac
9181
9182@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9183Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9184@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9185describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9186On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9187@end defmac
9188
9189@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9190A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9191continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9192exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9193operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9194must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9195with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9196defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9197@end defmac
9198
9199@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9200Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9201the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9202a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9203constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9204if backslash is correct for your system.
9205@end defmac
9206
9207@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9208Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9209outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9210variable.
9211@end defmac
9212
9213@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9214The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9215for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9216@end defmac
9217
9218@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9219The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9220for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9221provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9222@end defmac
9223
9224@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9225The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9226for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9227``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9228@end defmac
9229
9230@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9231The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9232passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9233do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9234@end defmac
9235
9236@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9237Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9238arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9239in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9240code.
9241@end defmac
9242
9243@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9244Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9245the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9246relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9247an absolute address.
9248@end defmac
9249
9250@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9251Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9252the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9253start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9254@end defmac
9255
9256@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9257Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9258@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9259macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9260number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9261generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9262number for a type number.
9263@end defmac
9264
9265@node DBX Hooks
9266@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9267
9268@c prevent bad page break with this line
9269These are hooks for DBX format.
9270
9271@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9272Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9273information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9274argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9275@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9276@end defmac
9277
9278@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9279Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9280@end defmac
9281
9282@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9283Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9284output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9285@end defmac
9286
9287@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9288A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9289number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9290@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9291invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9292unique labels in the assembly output.
9293
9294This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9295if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9296@end defmac
9297
9298@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9299Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9300@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9301On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9302disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9303@end defmac
9304
9305@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9306Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9307extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9308feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9309@end defmac
9310
9311@node File Names and DBX
9312@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9313
9314@c prevent bad page break with this line
9315This describes file names in DBX format.
9316
9317@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9318A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9319@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9320file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9321This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9322
9323This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9324for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9325
9326It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9327text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9328to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9329@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9330@end defmac
9331
9332@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9333Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9334of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9335the beginning of the file.
9336@end defmac
9337
9338@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9339Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9340that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9341an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9342@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9343@end defmac
9344
9345@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9346A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9347compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9348written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9349
9350If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9351of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9352@end defmac
9353
9354@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9355Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9356@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9357the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9358whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9359@end defmac
9360
9361@need 2000
9362@node SDB and DWARF
9363@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9364
9365@c prevent bad page break with this line
9366Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9367
9368@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9369Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9370for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9371@end defmac
9372
9373@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9374Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9375debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9376
9377@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9378Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9379be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9380value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9381@end deftypefn
9382
9383To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9384define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9385@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9386prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9387as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9388@end defmac
9389
9390@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9391Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9392Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9393(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9394exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9395how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9396@end defmac
9397
f0a0390e
RH
9398@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9399This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9400unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9401@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9402return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9403
9404A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9405is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9406
9407A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9408This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9409@end deftypefn
9410
38f8b050
JR
9411@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9412Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9413line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9414tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9415@end defmac
9416
9730bc27
TT
9417@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9418
38f8b050
JR
9419@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9420A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9421@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9422@end defmac
9423
9424@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9425A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9426between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9427slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9428@end defmac
9429
9430@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9431A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9432section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9433given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9434@end defmac
9435
9436@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9437A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9438reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9439@end defmac
9440
9441@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9442A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9443the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9444is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9445is referenced by a function.
9446@end defmac
9447
9448@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9449If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9450reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9451@end deftypefn
9452
9453@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9454Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9455SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9456macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9457not define them yourself.
9458@end defmac
9459
9460@defmac SDB_DELIM
9461Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9462SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9463delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9464a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9465required.
9466@end defmac
9467
9468@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9469Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9470union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9471allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9472it.
9473@end defmac
9474
9475@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9476Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9477enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9478assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9479@end defmac
9480
9481@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9482A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9483number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9484@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9485@end defmac
9486
9487@need 2000
9488@node VMS Debug
9489@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9490
9491@c prevent bad page break with this line
9492Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9493
9494@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9495Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9496in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9497is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9498@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9499behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9500@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9501@end defmac
9502
9503@node Floating Point
9504@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9505@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9506@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9507
9508While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9509there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9510means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9511in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9512doing the compilation.
9513
9514Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9515range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9516the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9517safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9518the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9519emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9520target floating point formats are identical.
9521
9522The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9523use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9524floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9525their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9526
9527@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9528The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9529machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9530array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9531quantity.
9532@end defmac
9533
9534@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9535Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9536floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9537@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9538@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9539@end deftypefn
9540
9541@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9542Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9543@end deftypefn
9544
9545@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9546Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9547@end deftypefn
9548
9549@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9550Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9551@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9552@end deftypefn
9553
9554@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9555Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9556representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9557decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9558defined by the C language for both.
9559@end deftypefn
9560
9561@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9562Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9563@end deftypefn
9564
9565@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9566Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9567@end deftypefn
9568
9569@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9570Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9571@end deftypefn
9572
9573@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9574Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9575@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9576variable).
9577
9578The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9579following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9580@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9581
9582If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9583target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9584@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9585@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9586@end deftypefn
9587
9588@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9589Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9590@end deftypefn
9591
9592@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9593Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9594@end deftypefn
9595
9596@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9597Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9598return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9599appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9600precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9601@end deftypefn
9602
9603@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9604Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9605which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9606integral, it is truncated.
9607@end deftypefn
9608
9609@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9610Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9611into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9612value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9613@end deftypefn
9614
9615@node Mode Switching
9616@section Mode Switching Instructions
9617@cindex mode switching
9618The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9619
9620@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9621Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9622switching in an optimizing compilation.
9623
9624For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9625floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9626the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9627operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9628purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9629be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9630or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9631
9632You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9633which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9634return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9635If you define this macro, you also have to define
9636@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9637@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9638@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9639are optional.
9640@end defmac
9641
9642@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9643If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9644initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9645N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9646of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9647The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9648zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9649entity in question.
9650In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9651represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9652switch is needed / supplied.
9653@end defmac
9654
9655@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9656@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9657@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9658return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9659@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9660be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9661@end defmac
9662
9663@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9664If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9665mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9666different from the incoming mode).
9667@end defmac
9668
9669@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9670If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9671mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9672@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9673is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9674@end defmac
9675
9676@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9677If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9678mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9679@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9680is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9681@end defmac
9682
9683@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9684This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96850 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9686lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9687for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9688(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9689@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9690@end defmac
9691
9692@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9693Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9694@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9695the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9696@end defmac
9697
9698@node Target Attributes
9699@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9700@cindex target attributes
9701@cindex machine attributes
9702@cindex attributes, target-specific
9703
9704Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9705These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9706be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9707
9708@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9709If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9710attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9711specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9712entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9713take.
9714@end deftypevr
9715
9716@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9717If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9718machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9719given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9720subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9721false for all machine-specific attributes.
9722@end deftypefn
9723
9724@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9725If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9726@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9727and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9728generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9729supposed always to be compatible.
9730@end deftypefn
9731
9732@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9733If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9734the newly defined @var{type}.
9735@end deftypefn
9736
9737@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9738Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9739handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9740@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9741that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9742function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9743merging.
9744@end deftypefn
9745
9746@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9747Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9748handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9749@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9750@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9751when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9752attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9753call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9754
9755@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9756If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9757for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9758@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9759will then define a function called
9760@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9761the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9762add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9763to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9764@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9765@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9766@end deftypefn
9767
9768@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9769
9770@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9771Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9772@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9773default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9774@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9775of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9776on this implementation detail.
9777@end defmac
9778
9779@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9780Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9781when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9782wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9783the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9784created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9785for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9786shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9787the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9788attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9789needed.
9790@end deftypefn
9791
9792@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9793@cindex inlining
9794This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9795into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9796attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9797target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9798@end deftypefn
9799
9800@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9801This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9802it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9803options for the current function that might be different than the
9804options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9805@code{true} if the options are valid.
9806
9807The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9808the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9809@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9810@end deftypefn
9811
9812@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9813This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9814in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9815options.
9816@xref{Option file format}.
9817@end deftypefn
9818
9819@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9820This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9821information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9822function specific options.
9823@end deftypefn
9824
9825@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9826This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9827information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9828function specific options.
9829@end deftypefn
9830
56cb42ea 9831@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9832This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9833set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9834input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9835@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9836@end deftypefn
9837
9838@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9839Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9840a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9841@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9842once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9843
9844Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9845@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9846
9847If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9848changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9849@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9850@end deftypefn
9851
9852@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9853This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9854cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9855default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9856specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9857@end deftypefn
9858
9859@node Emulated TLS
9860@section Emulating TLS
9861@cindex Emulated TLS
9862
9863For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9864specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9865used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9866configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9867the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9868layer.
9869
9870The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9871object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9872which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9873address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9874
9875@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9876Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9877object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9878emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9879@end deftypevr
9880
9881@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9882Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9883program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9884initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9885have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9886registration function to be used.
9887@end deftypevr
9888
9889@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9890Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9891be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9892any section.
9893@end deftypevr
9894
9895@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9896Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9897placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9898section.
9899@end deftypevr
9900
9901@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9902Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9903The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9904@end deftypevr
9905
9906@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9907Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9908default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9909@end deftypevr
9910
9911@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9912Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9913object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9914@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9915@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9916for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9917@end deftypefn
9918
9919@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9920Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9921TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9922is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9923initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9924@end deftypefn
9925
9926@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9927Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9928fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9929single objects. The default is false.
9930@end deftypevr
9931
9932@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9933Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9934may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9935@end deftypevr
9936
9937@node MIPS Coprocessors
9938@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9939@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9940
9941The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9942coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9943accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9944and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9945
9946@smallexample
9947 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9948 unsigned int d;
9949
9950 d = cp0count + 3;
9951@end smallexample
9952
9953(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9954names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9955overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9956
9957Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9958be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9959later in the function.
9960
9961Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9962the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9963floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9964
9965There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9966you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9967
9968@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9969A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9970alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9971@smallexample
9972@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9973@end smallexample
9974Default: empty.
9975@end defmac
9976
9977@node PCH Target
9978@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9979@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9980
9981@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9982This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9983@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9984@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9985@end deftypefn
9986
9987@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9988This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9989compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9990if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9991be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9992
9993@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9994when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9995It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9996compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9997
9998The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9999suitable for most targets.
10000@end deftypefn
10001
10002@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
10003If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10004@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10005of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10006@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10007value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10008@end deftypefn
10009
10010@node C++ ABI
10011@section C++ ABI parameters
10012@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10013
10014@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
10015Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10016These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10017default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10018@end deftypefn
10019
10020@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
10021This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10022@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10023@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10024@end deftypefn
10025
10026@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
10027This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10028whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10029known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10030@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10031IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10032@end deftypefn
10033
10034@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10035This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10036array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10037@end deftypefn
10038
10039@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10040If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10041class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10042will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10043to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10044modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10045backend's targeted operating system.
10046@end deftypefn
10047
10048@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10049This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10050the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10051@code{false}.
10052@end deftypefn
10053
10054@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10055This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10056which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10057table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10058Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10059the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10060some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10061method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10062@end deftypefn
10063
10064@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10065
10066@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10067This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10068similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10069external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10070classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10071unit will not be COMDAT.
10072@end deftypefn
10073
10074@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10075This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10076the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10077be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10078@end deftypefn
10079
10080@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10081This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10082should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10083is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10084@end deftypefn
10085
10086@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10087This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10088in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10089destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10090shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10091unloaded. The default is to return false.
10092@end deftypefn
10093
10094@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10095
10096@node Named Address Spaces
10097@section Adding support for named address spaces
10098@cindex named address spaces
10099
10100The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10101standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10102support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10103processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10104GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10105address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10106spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10107@code{const} type attributes.
10108
10109Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10110pointers to the generic address space.
10111
10112For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10113to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10114processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10115issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10116local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10117address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10118@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10119always 32 bits).
10120
10121Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10122range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10123address space.
10124
10125To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10126the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10127the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10128named address space #1:
10129@smallexample
10130#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10131c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10132@end smallexample
10133
10134@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10135Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10136@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10137The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10138generic address space only.
10139@end deftypefn
10140
10141@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10142Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10143@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10144The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10145generic address space only.
10146@end deftypefn
10147
10148@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10149Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10150with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10151hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10152except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10153version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10154@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10155target hooks for the given address space.
10156@end deftypefn
10157
10158@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10159Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10160@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10161parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10162finished. This target hook is the same as the
10163@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10164explicit named address space support.
10165@end deftypefn
10166
10167@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10168Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10169with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10170hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10171except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10172@end deftypefn
10173
10174@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10175Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10176contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10177a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10178will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10179arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10180converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10181@end deftypefn
10182
10183@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10184Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10185@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10186space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10187to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10188guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10189as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10190@end deftypefn
10191
10192@node Misc
10193@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10194@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10195
10196@c prevent bad page break with this line
10197Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10198
10199@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10200Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10201has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10202conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10203blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10204set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10205to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10206@end defmac
10207
10208@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10209Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10210has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10211conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10212blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10213set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10214to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10215@end defmac
10216
10217@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10218An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10219elements of a jump-table should have.
10220@end defmac
10221
10222@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10223Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10224when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10225it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10226To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10227make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10228The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10229flags can be updated.
10230@end defmac
10231
10232@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10233Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10234should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10235jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10236contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10237is in effect.
10238@end defmac
10239
10240@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10241This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10242is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10243The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10244five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10245@end deftypefn
10246
10247@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10248Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10249statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10250advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10251of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10252targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10253@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10254@code{false} otherwise.
10255@end defmac
10256
10257@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10258Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10259smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10260Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10261@end defmac
10262
10263@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10264Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10265memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10266bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10267zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10268of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10269insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10270@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10271
10272This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10273greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10274value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10275@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10276define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10277
10278You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10279the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10280of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10281when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10282integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10283
10284You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10285mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10286@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10287is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10288@end defmac
10289
10290@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10291Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10292extends.
10293@end defmac
10294
10295@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10296Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10297point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10298unsigned one.
10299@end defmac
10300
10301@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10302When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10303divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10304the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10305that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10306of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10307has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10308@end deftypefn
10309
10310@defmac MOVE_MAX
10311The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10312between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10313@end defmac
10314
10315@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10316The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10317between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10318is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10319constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10320at run-time.
10321@end defmac
10322
10323@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10324A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10325actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10326of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10327this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10328a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10329truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10330instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10331include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10332also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10333arguments to bit-field instructions.
10334
10335If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10336position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10337instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10338
10339However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10340only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10341bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10342such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10343the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10344
10345You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10346@end defmac
10347
10348@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10349@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10350This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10351deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10352@xref{shift patterns}.
10353
10354On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10355shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10356equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10357this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10358otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10359particular behavior is guaranteed.
10360
10361Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10362@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10363that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10364
10365The default implementation of this function returns
10366@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10367and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10368@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10369nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10370by overriding it.
10371@end deftypefn
10372
10373@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10374A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10375``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10376bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10377operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10378
10379On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10380
10381@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10382@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10383When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10384modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10385If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10386such cases may improve things.
10387@end defmac
10388
10389@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10390The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10391are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10392@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10393sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10394otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10395representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10396@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10397@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10398@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10399widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10400
10401Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10402value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10403as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10404@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10405
10406Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10407describe two related properties. If you define
10408@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10409to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10410extension.
10411
10412In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10413@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10414@code{mode}.
10415@end deftypefn
10416
10417@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10418A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10419with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10420(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10421apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10422comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10423
10424A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10425comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10426and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10427which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10428true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10429operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10430@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10431@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10432the compiler.
10433
10434If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10435generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10436replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10437the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10438For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10439@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10440@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10441expression
10442
10443@smallexample
10444(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10445@end smallexample
10446
10447@noindent
10448can be converted to
10449
10450@smallexample
10451(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10452@end smallexample
10453
10454@noindent
10455where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10456tested into the sign bit.
10457
10458There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10459for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10460but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10461are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10462perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10463comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10464
10465Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10466from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10467choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10468to be used:
10469
10470@itemize @bullet
10471@item
10472Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10473@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10474``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10475comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10476combine the normalization with other operations.
10477
10478@item
10479For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10480slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10481other machines.
10482
10483@item
10484As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10485exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10486others.
10487
10488@item
10489Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10490@end itemize
10491
10492Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10493@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10494instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10495those cases, e.g., one matching
10496
10497@smallexample
10498(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10499@end smallexample
10500
10501Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10502condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10503@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10504machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10505and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10506@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10507@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10508find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10509
10510If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10511not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10512instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10513@end defmac
10514
10515@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10516A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10517returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10518Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10519floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10520this macro.
10521@end defmac
10522
10523@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10524A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10525for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10526mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10527this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10528return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10529this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10530@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10531the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10532given mode.
10533@end defmac
10534
10535@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10536@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10537A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10538for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10539A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10540If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10541evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10542entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10543the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10544In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10545this value.
10546
10547If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10548@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10549
10550This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10551relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10552is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10553to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10554
10555Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10556and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10557visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10558to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10559breaking the API@.
10560@end defmac
10561
10562@defmac Pmode
10563An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10564this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10565pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10566On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10567modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10568
10569The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10570@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10571@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10572to @code{Pmode}.
10573@end defmac
10574
10575@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10576An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10577being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10578where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10579@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10580size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10581as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10582@end defmac
10583
10584@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10585In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10586constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10587hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10588where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10589strict conformance to the C Standard.
10590
10591Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10592convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10593files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10594@end defmac
10595
10596@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10597Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10598This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10599C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10600@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10601@end defmac
10602
10603@findex #pragma
10604@findex pragma
10605@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10606Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10607If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10608@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10609for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10610setup required for the pragmas.
10611
10612The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10613other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10614definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10615
10616If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10617defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10618
10619Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10620@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10621silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10622@end defmac
10623
10624@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10625@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10626
10627Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10628@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10629@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10630pragma of the form
10631
10632@smallexample
10633#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10634@end smallexample
10635
10636@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10637@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10638routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10639on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10640@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10641callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10642a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10643arguments of pragmas registered with
10644@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10645pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10646
10647Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10648compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10649other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10650to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10651building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10652variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10653target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10654the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10655code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10656rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10657how to build this object file.
10658@end deftypefun
10659
10660@findex #pragma
10661@findex pragma
10662@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10663Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10664pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10665[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10666
10667The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10668within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10669@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10670the behavior to the default.
10671
10672A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10673(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10674When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10675of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10676bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10677and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10678chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10679size is allocated).
10680
10681If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10682the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10683used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10684precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10685may affect its placement.
10686
10687The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10688@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10689of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10690@end defmac
10691
10692@findex #pragma
10693@findex pragma
10694@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10695Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10696style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10697pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10698alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10699the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10700pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10701invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10702that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10703value.
10704@end defmac
10705
10706@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10707Define this macro, as well as
10708@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10709arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10710@end defmac
10711
10712@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10713
10714@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10715If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10716the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10717This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10718@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10719@end defmac
10720
10721@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10722Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10723identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10724not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10725there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10726@end defmac
10727
10728@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10729Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10730@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10731G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10732@samp{.} is used instead.
10733@end defmac
10734
10735@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10736Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10737@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10738have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10739are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10740@end defmac
10741
10742@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10743Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10744delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10745even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10746@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10747every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10748or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10749you should define this macro.
10750
10751You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10752@end defmac
10753
10754@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10755Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10756delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10757even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10758@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10759some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10760are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10761define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10762instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10763slot of @var{insn}.
10764
10765You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10766@end defmac
10767
10768@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10769Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10770global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10771symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10772instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10773from shared libraries (DLLs).
10774
10775You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10776@end defmac
10777
10778@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10779This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10780any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10781It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10782clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10783corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10784clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10785@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10786for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10787@end deftypefn
10788
10789@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10790Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10791in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10792@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10793separate math library.
10794
d9d16a19 10795You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10796@end defmac
10797
10798@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10799Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10800specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10801
10802You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10803is wrong.
10804@end defmac
10805
10806@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10807Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10808functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10809Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10810to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10811if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10812for cross-profiling.
10813@end defmac
10814
10815@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10816
10817A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10818conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10819@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
108201 if it does use cc0.
10821@end defmac
10822
10823@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10824Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10825conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10826@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10827contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10828and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10829then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10830@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10831@end defmac
10832
10833@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10834Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10835if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10836@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10837being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10838@end defmac
10839
10840@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10841A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10842be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10843a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10844about the currently processed blocks.
10845@end defmac
10846
10847@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10848A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10849converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10850can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10851to by @var{ce_info}.
10852@end defmac
10853
10854@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10855A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10856converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10857can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10858to by @var{ce_info}.
10859@end defmac
10860
10861@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10862A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10863structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10864@end defmac
10865
10866@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10867If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10868added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10869by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10870@end defmac
10871
10872@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10873If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10874instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10875just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10876
10877The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10878it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10879laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10880Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10881
10882You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10883definition is null.
10884@end deftypefn
10885
10886@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10887Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10888that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10889necessary setup.
10890
10891Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10892instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10893they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10894instructions or prefetch instructions).
10895
10896To create a built-in function, call the function
10897@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10898which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10899up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10900only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10901@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10902@end deftypefn
10903
10904@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10905Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10906that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10907builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10908If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10909if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10910If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10911@code{error_mark_node}.
10912@end deftypefn
10913
10914@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10915
10916Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10917@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10918function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10919convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10920@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10921@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10922ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10923built-in function.
10924@end deftypefn
10925
d66f5459 10926@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10927Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10928was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10929@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10930implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10931declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10932arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10933complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10934another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10935@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10936@end deftypefn
10937
08914aaa 10938@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10939Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10940@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10941built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10942the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10943The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10944call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10945@end deftypefn
10946
10947@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10948
10949Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10950low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10951could not be applied.
10952
10953Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10954instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10955the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10956By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10957loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10958@end deftypefn
10959
10960@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10961
10962Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10963Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10964@var{branch2} is possible.
10965
10966On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10967filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10968may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10969@end defmac
10970
10971@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10972This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10973Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10974PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10975of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10976@end deftypefn
10977
10978@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10979
10980When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10981register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10982to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10983it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10984is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10985that had its initial value copied by using
10986@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10987Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10988to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10989the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10990@code{MEM}.
10991If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10992it might decide to use another register anyways.
10993You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10994that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10995register in question will not be clobbered.
10996The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10997allocation.
10998@end deftypefn
10999
11000@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
11001This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11002@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11003this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11004@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11005to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11006passed along.
11007@end deftypefn
11008
11009@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
11010The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11011context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11012the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11013per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11014attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11015The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11016and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11017and is returning to processing at the top level.
11018The default hook function does nothing.
11019
11020GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11021some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11022situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11023or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11024@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11025outside of any function scope.
11026@end deftypefn
11027
11028@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11029Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11030files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11031use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11032@end defmac
11033
11034@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11035Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11036automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11037do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11038executable files.
11039@end defmac
11040
11041@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11042If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11043specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11044Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11045object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11046lists.
11047@end defmac
11048
11049@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11050Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11051method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11052must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11053For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11054the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11055defined as this expression:
11056
11057@smallexample
11058build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11059 build_tree_list
11060 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11061 NULL))
11062@end smallexample
11063@end defmac
11064
11065@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
11066This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11067instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11068every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11069reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11070
11071@smallexample
11072static bool
11073cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11074@{
11075 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11076@}
11077@end smallexample
11078@end deftypefn
11079
11080@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11081This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11082optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11083usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11084re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11085to inter-block scheduling.
11086@end deftypefn
11087
11088@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11089Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11090registers
11091that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11092returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11093that all target registers in the class returned by
11094@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11095saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11096epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11097true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11098to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11099to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11100@end deftypefn
11101
11102@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11103This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11104This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11105modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11106@end deftypefn
11107
11108@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11109This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11110should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11111the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11112the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11113is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11114number of memory accesses.
11115@end deftypefn
11116
11117@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11118If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11119that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11120that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11121constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11122more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11123system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11124The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11125@end defmac
11126
11127@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11128This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11129target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11130are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11131The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11132@end deftypefn
11133
11134@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11135This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11136target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11137indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11138@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11139@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11140@end deftypefn
11141
11142@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11143This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11144The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11145systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11146that are different from @option{-I}.
11147@end deftypefn
11148
11149@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11150This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11151for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11152@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11153functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11154@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11155@end defmac
11156
11157@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11158If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11159target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11160option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11161@end defmac
11162
11163@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11164If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11165@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11166@end defmac
11167
11168@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11169If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11170target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11171default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11172@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11173@end defmac
11174
11175@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11176If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11177@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11178@end defmac
11179
11180@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11181If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11182routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11183and scanf formatter settings.
11184@end defmac
11185
11186@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11187If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11188guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11189main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11190important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11191many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11192``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11193and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11194@end deftypevr
11195
11196@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11197If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11198illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11199with prototype @var{typelist}.
11200@end deftypefn
11201
11202@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11203If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11204invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11205if validity should be determined by the front end.
11206@end deftypefn
11207
11208@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11209If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11210invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11211@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11212if validity should be determined by the front end.
11213@end deftypefn
11214
11215@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11216If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11217invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11218and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11219the front end.
11220@end deftypefn
11221
11222@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11223If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11224invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11225or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11226the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11227@end deftypefn
11228
11229@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11230If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11231invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11232or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11233the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11234@end deftypefn
11235
11236@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11237If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11238@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11239analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11240front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11241target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11242This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11243@end deftypefn
11244
11245@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11246If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11247@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11248or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11249This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11250conversion rules.
11251This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11252@end deftypefn
11253
11254@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11255This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11256classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11257SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11258@end defmac
11259
11260@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11261This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11262NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11263@end defmac
11264
11265@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11266Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11267to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11268call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11269and the associated definitions of those functions.
11270@end defmac
11271
11272@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11273Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11274necessary.
11275@end deftypefn
11276
11277@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11278This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11279different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11280argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11281is needed.
11282@end deftypefn
11283
11284@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11285When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11286arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11287stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11288debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11289@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11290cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11291to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11292false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11293@end deftypefn
11294
11295@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11296On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11297a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11298is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11299is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11300subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11301the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11302available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11303constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11304down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11305@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11306accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11307value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11308MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11309@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11310is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr